blob: 52cc4328e3847fb153c8e7a96a92a9f7ed485103 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaub3066502017-11-26 19:50:17 +01005 version 1.9
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau96079492018-11-11 10:43:39 +01007 2018/11/11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011110. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011210.1. Limitation
11310.2. Setup
11410.2.1. Cache section
11510.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116
1171. Quick reminder about HTTP
118----------------------------
119
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100120When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
122on almost anything found in the contents.
123
124However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
125formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
126correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
127
128
1291.1. The HTTP transaction model
130-------------------------------
131
132The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100133to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
135connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136will involve a new connection :
137
138 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
139
140In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
141establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
142by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
143length.
144
145Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
146to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
147however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
148response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
149header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
154power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
155but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200156a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100158Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
160second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
161page :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
166latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
167correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
168the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100169server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
172time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
173are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
174parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
175carry the stream identifier.
176
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100177By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
178connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
179leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100180start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
181processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
182waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200183
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200184HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100185 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
186 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
187 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100188 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200189 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100191For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
192the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
194is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
195servers.
196
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197
1981.2. HTTP request
199-----------------
200
201First, let's consider this HTTP request :
202
203 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100204 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
206 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
207 3 User-agent: my small browser
208 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
209 5 Accept: image/png
210
211
2121.2.1. The Request line
213-----------------------
214
215Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
216
217 - a METHOD : GET
218 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
219 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
220
221All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
222which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
223followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
224is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
225desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
226the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
227
228The URI itself can have several forms :
229
230 - A "relative URI" :
231
232 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
233
234 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
235 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
236
237 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
238
239 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
240
241 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
242 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
243 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
244 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
245 must accept this form too.
246
247 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
248 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
249 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100250
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200251 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
252 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
253 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
254 other protocols too.
255
256In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
257mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
258on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
259It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
260specific to the language, framework or application in use.
261
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100262HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100263assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100264However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
265received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
266processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
267as well as in server logs.
268
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200269
2701.2.2. The request headers
271--------------------------
272
273The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
274beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
275an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
276Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
277values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
278encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
279the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
280define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
281
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100282Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200283their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100284"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
285as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200286
287The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
288that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
289is one valid form of empty line.
290
291Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
292headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
293about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
294application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
295
296Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000297 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
299 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
300 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
301
302
3031.3. HTTP response
304------------------
305
306An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
307messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
308
309 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100310 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
312 2 Content-length: 350
313 3 Content-Type: text/html
314
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
316codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
317response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100318continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
319the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
320following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
321sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
322(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
323correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
324such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
325state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
326over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
327if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
328information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200330
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003311.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332------------------------
333
334Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
335
336 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
337 - a status code : 200
338 - a reason : OK
339
340The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
342 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
343 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
344 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
345 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000347Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100348"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200349found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
350messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
351or "Authentication Required".
352
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100353HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200354
355 Code When / reason
356 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
357 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
358 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100360 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
361 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362 400 for an invalid or too large request
363 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
364 accessing the stats page)
365 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
366 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
367 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
368 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
369 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
370 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
371 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
372 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
373 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
374
375The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3764.2).
377
378
3791.3.2. The response headers
380---------------------------
381
382Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
383the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
384details.
385
386
3872. Configuring HAProxy
388----------------------
389
3902.1. Configuration file format
391------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200392
393HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
394
395 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
396 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
397 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
398 "frontend" and "backend".
399
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100400The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
401referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200402delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200404
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004052.2. Quoting and escaping
406-------------------------
407
408HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
409many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
410with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
411single quotes.
412
413If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
414them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
415escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
416
417Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
418
419 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
420 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
421 \\ to use a backslash
422 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
423 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
424
425Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
426the interpretation of:
427
428 space as a parameter separator
429 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
430 # hash as a comment start
431
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
433-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
434backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
435
436Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200437quoting.
438
439Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
440nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
441
442Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
443equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
444
445 Example:
446 # those are equivalents:
447 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
448 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
449 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
450 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
452
453 # those are equivalents:
454 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
455 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
458
459
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004602.3. Environment variables
461--------------------------
462
463HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
464interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
465configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
466optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
467shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
468underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
469
470 Example:
471
472 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
473
474 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
475
476 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
477
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200478A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
479which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
480
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200481
4822.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200483----------------
484
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100485Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100486values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
487otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
488numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
489for every keyword. Supported units are :
490
491 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
492 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
493 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
494 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
495 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
496 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
497
498
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004992.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200500-------------
501
502 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
503 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
504 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
505 global
506 daemon
507 maxconn 256
508
509 defaults
510 mode http
511 timeout connect 5000ms
512 timeout client 50000ms
513 timeout server 50000ms
514
515 frontend http-in
516 bind *:80
517 default_backend servers
518
519 backend servers
520 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
521
522
523 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
524 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
525 global
526 daemon
527 maxconn 256
528
529 defaults
530 mode http
531 timeout connect 5000ms
532 timeout client 50000ms
533 timeout server 50000ms
534
535 listen http-in
536 bind *:80
537 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
538
539
540Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
541
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100542 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200543
544
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005453. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546--------------------
547
548Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
549are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
550of them have command-line equivalents.
551
552The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
553
554 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200555 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200557 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200558 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200559 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200560 - description
561 - deviceatlas-json-file
562 - deviceatlas-log-level
563 - deviceatlas-separator
564 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900565 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200566 - gid
567 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100568 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200569 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200570 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100571 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200572 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200574 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200575 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100577 - presetenv
578 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200579 - uid
580 - ulimit-n
581 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100582 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200583 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200585 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-options
587 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200588 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - ssl-default-server-options
590 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100591 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100592 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100593 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100594 - 51degrees-data-file
595 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200596 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200597 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100598 - wurfl-data-file
599 - wurfl-information-list
600 - wurfl-information-list-separator
601 - wurfl-engine-mode
602 - wurfl-cache-size
603 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200606 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200608 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100609 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100610 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100611 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200612 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200613 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200614 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200615 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200616 - noepoll
617 - nokqueue
618 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100619 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300620 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000621 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200622 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200623 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200624 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000625 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000626 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200627 - tune.buffers.limit
628 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200629 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200630 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100631 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200632 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200633 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200634 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100635 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200636 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200637 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100638 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100639 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100640 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100641 - tune.lua.session-timeout
642 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200643 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100644 - tune.maxaccept
645 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200646 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200647 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200648 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100649 - tune.rcvbuf.client
650 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100651 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200652 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100653 - tune.sndbuf.client
654 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100655 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100656 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200657 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100658 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200659 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200660 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100661 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200662 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100663 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200664 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
665 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
666 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100667 - tune.zlib.memlevel
668 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100669
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200670 * Debugging
671 - debug
672 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200673
674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006753.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200676------------------------------------
677
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200678ca-base <dir>
679 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200680 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
681 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200682
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200683chroot <jail dir>
684 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
685 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
686 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
687 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
688 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100689 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100690
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100691cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
692 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
693 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
694 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
695 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
696 set. These sets have the format
697
698 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
699
700 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100701 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100702 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
703 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100704 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
705 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100706 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100707 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100708 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100709 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100710 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
711 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
712 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
713 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100714
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100715 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
716 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
717 on the machine's word size.
718
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100719 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100720 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
721 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
722 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
723 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
724 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
725 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100726
727 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100728 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
729
730 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
731 # first 4 CPUs
732
733 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
734 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
735 # word size.
736
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100737 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100738 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100739 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
740 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
741 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
742
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100743 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
744 # and so on.
745 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
746 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
747 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
748
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100749 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100750 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
751 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
752 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
753
754 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
755 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
756 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
757
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
759 # and a thread range.
760 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
761 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
762 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
763
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200764crt-base <dir>
765 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
766 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
767 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
768
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200769daemon
770 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
771 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100772 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
773 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200774
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200775deviceatlas-json-file <path>
776 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100777 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200778
779deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100780 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200781 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
782
783deviceatlas-separator <char>
784 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
785 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
786
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100787deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200788 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
789 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
790 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100791
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900792external-check
793 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
794 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
795 See "option external-check".
796
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200797gid <number>
798 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
799 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
800 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100801 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
802 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200803 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100804
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100805hard-stop-after <time>
806 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
807
808 Arguments :
809 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
810 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
811 SIGUSR1 signal.
812
813 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
814 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
815 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
816
817 Example:
818 global
819 hard-stop-after 30s
820
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200821group <group name>
822 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
823 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100824
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200825log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100826 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100827 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100828 configured with "log global".
829
830 <address> can be one of:
831
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100832 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100833 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
834 port).
835
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100836 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
837 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
838 port).
839
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100840 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100841 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
842 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100843 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100844
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100845 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
846 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
847 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
848 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
849 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
850 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
851 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
852 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
853 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
854 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
855 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
856 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
857 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
858 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100859 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
860 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100861
862 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
863 "fd@2", see above.
864
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200865 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
866 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100867
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200868 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
869 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
870 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
871 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
872 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
873 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
874 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
875 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
876 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
877 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100878 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
879 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200880
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200881 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
882 one of the following :
883
884 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
885 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
886
887 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
888 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
889
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100890 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
891 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
892 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
893 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
894 logger consumes.
895
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100896 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
897 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
898 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
899 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
900
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100901 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200902
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100903 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
904 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
905 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
906
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100907 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
908 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
909 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
910 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200911
912 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200913 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
914 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
915 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
916 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
917 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
918 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200919
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200920 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200921
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100922log-send-hostname [<string>]
923 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
924 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
925 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
926 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
927 the logs.
928
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000929log-tag <string>
930 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
931 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
932 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100933 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000934
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100935lua-load <file>
936 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
937 used multiple times.
938
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100939master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200940 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
941 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
942 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100943 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200944 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
945 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100946 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
947 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
948 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
949 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
950 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200951
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100952 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200953
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200954nbproc <number>
955 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
956 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
957 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
958 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
959 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
960
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200961nbthread <number>
962 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
963 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
964 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
965 process. FOR NOW, THREADS SUPPORT IN HAPROXY IS HIGHLY EXPERIMENTAL AND IT
966 MUST BE ENABLED WITH CAUTION AND AT YOUR OWN RISK. See also "nbproc".
967
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200968pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100969 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200970 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
971 starting the process. See also "daemon".
972
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100973presetenv <name> <value>
974 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
975 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
976 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
977 and "unsetenv".
978
979resetenv [<name> ...]
980 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
981 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
982 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
983 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
984 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
985 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
986 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
987 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
988
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100989stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200990 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
991 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
992 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
993 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
994 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
995 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100996 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100997 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
998 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
999 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1000 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001001
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001002server-state-base <directory>
1003 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001004 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1005 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001006
1007server-state-file <file>
1008 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1009 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1010 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1011 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1012 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1013 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1014 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1015 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001016 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1017 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001018
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001019setenv <name> <value>
1020 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1021 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1022 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1023 and "unsetenv".
1024
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001025ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1026 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1027 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001028 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3 for all
1029 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
1030 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance
1031 a string such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). For
1032 TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites"
1033 keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1034
1035ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1036 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1037 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1038 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1039 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1040 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
1041 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites", and can
1042 be for instance a string such as
1043 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
1044 (without quotes). For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check
1045 the "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
1046 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001047
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001048ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1049 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1050 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1051 keyword to see available options.
1052
1053 Example:
1054 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001055 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001056
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001057ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1058 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1059 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001060 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3 with the server,
1061 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
1062 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration,
1063 please check the "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the
1064 "server" keyword for more information.
1065
1066ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1067 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1068 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1069 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1070 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1071 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
1072 "man 1 ciphers" under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration for
1073 TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword.
1074 Please check the "server" keyword for more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001075
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001076ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1077 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1078 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1079 keyword to see available options.
1080
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001081ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1082 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1083 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1084 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001085 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001086 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001087 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1088 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1089 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1090 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001091 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1092 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1093 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1094
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001095ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1096 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1097 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1098 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1099
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001100stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1101 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1102 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1103 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001104 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001105 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001106
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001107 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1108 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1109 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001110
1111stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1112 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1113 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001114 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001115
1116stats maxconn <connections>
1117 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1118 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1119
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001120uid <number>
1121 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1122 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1123 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1124 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1125
1126ulimit-n <number>
1127 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1128 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1129 option.
1130
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001131unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1132 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1133
1134 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1135 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1136 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1137 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1138 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1139 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1140 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1141 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1142 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1143 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1144
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001145unsetenv [<name> ...]
1146 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1147 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1148 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1149 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1150 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1151 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1152 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1153
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001154user <user name>
1155 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1156 See also "uid" and "group".
1157
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001158node <name>
1159 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1160
1161 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1162 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1163 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1164 traffic.
1165
1166description <text>
1167 Add a text that describes the instance.
1168
1169 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1170 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1171 "<" and ">" characters.
1172
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100117351degrees-data-file <file path>
1174 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001175 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001176
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001177 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001178 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1179
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000118051degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001181 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1182 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1183 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1184
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001185 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001186 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1187
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200118851degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001189 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1190 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1191
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001192 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1193 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1194
119551degrees-cache-size <number>
1196 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1197 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1198 By default, this cache is disabled.
1199
1200 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001201 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1202
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001203wurfl-data-file <file path>
1204 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1205 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1206
1207 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1208 with USE_WURFL=1.
1209
1210wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1211 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1212 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1213 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1214
1215 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1216
1217 Valid WURFL properties are:
1218 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1219
1220 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1221 device.
1222
1223 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1224 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1225
1226 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1227 particular web request.
1228
1229 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1230 used Libwurfl API version.
1231
1232 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1233 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1234 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1235
1236 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1237 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1238
1239 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1240 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1241
1242 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1243
1244 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1245
1246 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1247 with USE_WURFL=1.
1248
1249wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1250 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1251 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1252
1253 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1254 with USE_WURFL=1.
1255
1256wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1257 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1258 thus before the chroot.
1259
1260 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1261 with USE_WURFL=1.
1262
1263wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1264 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1265 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001266 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001267 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001268 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001269 mode is enabled by default.
1270
1271 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1272 with USE_WURFL=1.
1273
1274wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1275 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1276 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1277 - "0" : no cache is used.
1278 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1279 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1280 the highest performing option.
1281
1282 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1283 with USE_WURFL=1.
1284
1285wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1286 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1287 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1288
1289 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1290 with USE_WURFL=1.
1291
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012933.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001294-----------------------
1295
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001296max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1297 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1298 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1299 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1300 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1301 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1302 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1303 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1304 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1305
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001306maxconn <number>
1307 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1308 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1309 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001310 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1311 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1312 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1313 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001314 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1315 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1316 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1317 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1318 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001319
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001320maxconnrate <number>
1321 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1322 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1323 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1324 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1325 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1326 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1327 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1328 fairness.
1329
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001330maxcomprate <number>
1331 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001332 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001333 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1334 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1335 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001336 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001337 default value.
1338
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001339maxcompcpuusage <number>
1340 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1341 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1342 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1343 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1344 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1345 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1346 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1347 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1348
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001349maxpipes <number>
1350 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1351 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1352 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1353 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1354 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1355 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1356
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001357maxsessrate <number>
1358 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1359 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1360 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1361 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1362 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1363 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1364 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1365 fairness.
1366
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001367maxsslconn <number>
1368 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1369 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1370 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1371 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1372 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1373 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1374 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001375 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1376 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1377 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1378 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1379 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1380 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1381 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001382
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001383maxsslrate <number>
1384 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1385 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1386 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1387 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1388 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1389 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1390 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1391 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1392 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1393 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1394
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001395maxzlibmem <number>
1396 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1397 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1398 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001399 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1400 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1401 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1402
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001403noepoll
1404 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1405 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001406 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001407
1408nokqueue
1409 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1410 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1411 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1412
1413nopoll
1414 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1415 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001416 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001417 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001418
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001419nosplice
1420 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001421 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001422 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001423 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001424 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1425 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1426 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1427 "option splice-response".
1428
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001429nogetaddrinfo
1430 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1431 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1432
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001433noreuseport
1434 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1435 command line argument "-dR".
1436
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001437spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001438 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1439 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1440 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1441 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1442 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1443 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001444
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001445ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001446 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001447 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001448 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1449 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1450 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1451 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1452 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001453 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1454 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001455 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1456 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1457 openssl configuration file uses:
1458 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1459
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001460ssl-mode-async
1461 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001462 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001463 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1464 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1465 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1466 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1467 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001468
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001469tune.buffers.limit <number>
1470 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1471 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1472 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1473 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1474 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001475 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001476 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1477 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1478 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1479 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1480 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1481 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1482 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1483 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1484 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1485
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001486tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1487 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1488 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1489 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1490 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1491
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001492tune.bufsize <number>
1493 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1494 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1495 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1496 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1497 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1498 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1499 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001500 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1501 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1502 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001503 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1504 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001505
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001506tune.chksize <number>
1507 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1508 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1509 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1510 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1511 checks whenever possible.
1512
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001513tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1514 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1515 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1516 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1517 this value. The default value is 1.
1518
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001519tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1520 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1521 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1522 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1523 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1524 change it.
1525
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001526tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1527 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001528 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1529 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001530 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1531 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1532 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1533 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1534 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1535
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001536tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1537 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1538 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1539 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1540 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1541 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1542 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1543 recommended not to change this value.
1544
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001545tune.http.cookielen <number>
1546 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1547 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1548 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1549 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1550 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1551 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1552 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1553 to change this value.
1554
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001555tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001556 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1557 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001558 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001559 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001560 configuration directives too.
1561 The default value is 1024.
1562
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001563tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1564 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1565 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1566 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1567 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1568 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1569 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001570 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1571 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1572 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001573
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001574tune.idletimer <timeout>
1575 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1576 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1577 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1578 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1579 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1580 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001581 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001582 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1583 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1584
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001585tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1586 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001587 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001588 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1589 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001590 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001591 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1592 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1593
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001594tune.lua.maxmem
1595 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1596 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1597 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1598 memory.
1599
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001600tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1601 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001602 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1603 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001604 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001605
1606tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1607 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1608 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1609 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1610 check servers.
1611
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001612tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1613 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1614 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1615 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001616 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001617
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001618tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001619 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1620 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1621 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1622 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1623 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1624 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1625 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1626 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1627 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1628 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001629
1630tune.maxpollevents <number>
1631 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1632 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1633 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1634 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1635 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1636
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001637tune.maxrewrite <number>
1638 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1639 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1640 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1641 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1642 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1643 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1644 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1645 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1646 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1647 bufsize.
1648
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001649tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1650 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1651 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1652 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1653 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1654 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1655 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1656 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1657 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1658 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1659 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1660 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1661 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1662 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1663 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1664 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1665 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1666 setting this parameter to 0.
1667
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001668tune.pipesize <number>
1669 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1670 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1671 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1672 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1673 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1674 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1675
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001676tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1677tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1678 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1679 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1680 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1681 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001682 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001683 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1684 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1685
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001686tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001687 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001688 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1689 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1690 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1691 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1692
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001693tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1694 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1695 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1696 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1697
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001698tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1699tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1700 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1701 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1702 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1703 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001704 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001705 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1706 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1707 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1708 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1709 notifying haproxy again.
1710
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001711tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001712 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1713 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1714 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001715 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001716 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001717 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001718 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1719 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1720 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001721 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1722 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001723
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001724tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001725 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001726 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1727 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1728 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1729 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1730 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1731
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001732tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1733 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001734 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001735 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1736 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1737 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1738 being used for too long.
1739
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001740tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1741 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1742 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1743 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1744 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1745 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1746 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1747 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1748 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1749 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1750 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001751 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001752 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001753
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001754tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1755 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1756 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1757 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1758 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1759 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1760 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1761 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001762 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1763 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001764
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001765tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1766 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1767 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1768 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1769 1000 entries.
1770
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001771tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1772 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1773 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1774 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1775
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001776tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001777tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001778tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1779tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1780tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001781 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1782 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1783 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1784 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1785 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1786 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1787 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1788 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001789
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001790 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1791 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1792 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1793 all available space is consumed.
1794 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1795 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1796 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001797
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001798tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1799 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001800 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001801 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001802 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001803 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1804
1805tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1806 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1807 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001808 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1809 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001810
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018113.3. Debugging
1812--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001813
1814debug
1815 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1816 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1817 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1818 system startup.
1819
1820quiet
1821 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1822 line argument "-q".
1823
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001824
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018253.4. Userlists
1826--------------
1827It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1828http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1829it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1830
1831userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001832 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001833 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1834
1835group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001836 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001837 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1838 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1839
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001840user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1841 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001842 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1843 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001844 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1845 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1846 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1847 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001848
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001849 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1850 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1851 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1852 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1853 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1854 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1855 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1856 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1857 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001858
1859 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001860 userlist L1
1861 group G1 users tiger,scott
1862 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001863
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001864 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1865 user scott insecure-password elgato
1866 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001867
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001868 userlist L2
1869 group G1
1870 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001871
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001872 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1873 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1874 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001875
1876 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001877
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001878
18793.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001880----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001881It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1882several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1883instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1884values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1885automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1886In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1887using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1888tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1889reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1890Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1891that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1892each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001893
1894peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001895 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001896 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1897
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001898disabled
1899 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1900 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1901 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1902
1903enable
1904 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1905
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001906peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1907 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1908 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1909 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1910 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1911 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1912 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1913
1914 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1915 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1916
1917 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1918 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1919 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1920 across all peers.
1921
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001922 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1923 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001924
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001925 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001926 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001927 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1928 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1929 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001930
1931 backend mybackend
1932 mode tcp
1933 balance roundrobin
1934 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1935 stick on src
1936
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001937 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1938 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001939
1940
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090019413.6. Mailers
1942------------
1943It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1944If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1945in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1946
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001947mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001948 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1949 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1950
1951mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1952 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1953
1954 Example:
1955 mailers mymailers
1956 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1957 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1958
1959 backend mybackend
1960 mode tcp
1961 balance roundrobin
1962
1963 email-alert mailers mymailers
1964 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1965 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1966
1967 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1968 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1969
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001970timeout mail <time>
1971 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1972 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1973 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1974 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1975
1976 Example:
1977 mailers mymailers
1978 timeout mail 20s
1979 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001980
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019814. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001982----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001983
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001984Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001985 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001986 - frontend <name>
1987 - backend <name>
1988 - listen <name>
1989
1990A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1991its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1992section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001993section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001994
1995A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1996connections.
1997
1998A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1999to forward incoming connections.
2000
2001A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2002parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2003
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002004All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2005'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2006case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2007
2008Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2009logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2010proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2011However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2012name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2013
2014Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2015and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002016bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002017protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2018modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2019arbitrary criteria.
2020
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002021In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2022a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002023the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002024
2025 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2026 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2027 between responses and new requests.
2028
2029 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2030 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2031 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002032 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing. It
2033 is supported only on frontends.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002034
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002035 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2036 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2037 client-facing connection remains open.
2038
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002039 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2040 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002041
2042The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2043frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2044following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002045weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002046
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002047 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002048
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002049 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2050 ----+-----+-----+----
2051 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2052 ----+-----+-----+----
2053 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2054 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2055 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2056 ----+-----+-----+----
2057 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002058
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002059
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002060
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2062--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002064The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2065limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2066they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2067limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002068marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002069option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002070and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2071with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2072specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002073
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002074
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002075 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2076------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2077acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002078appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002079backlog X X X -
2080balance X - X X
2081bind - X X -
2082bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002083block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002084capture cookie - X X -
2085capture request header - X X -
2086capture response header - X X -
2087clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002088compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002089contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2090cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002091declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002092default-server X - X X
2093default_backend X X X -
2094description - X X X
2095disabled X X X X
2096dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002097email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002098email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002099email-alert mailers X X X X
2100email-alert myhostname X X X X
2101email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002102enabled X X X X
2103errorfile X X X X
2104errorloc X X X X
2105errorloc302 X X X X
2106-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2107errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002108force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002109filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002110fullconn X - X X
2111grace X X X X
2112hash-type X - X X
2113http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002114http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002115http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002116http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002117http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002118http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002119http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002120id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002121ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002122load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002123log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002124log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002125log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002126log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002127max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002128maxconn X X X -
2129mode X X X X
2130monitor fail - X X -
2131monitor-net X X X -
2132monitor-uri X X X -
2133option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2134option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2135option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2136option allbackups (*) X - X X
2137option checkcache (*) X - X X
2138option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2139option contstats (*) X X X -
2140option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2141option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002142option forceclose (deprectated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002143-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2144option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002145option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002146option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002147option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002148option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002149option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002150option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002151option http-tunnel (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002152option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002153option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002154option httpchk X - X X
2155option httpclose (*) X X X X
2156option httplog X X X X
2157option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002158option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002159option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002160option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002161option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2162option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2163option logasap (*) X X X -
2164option mysql-check X - X X
2165option nolinger (*) X X X X
2166option originalto X X X X
2167option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002168option pgsql-check X - X X
2169option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002170option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002171option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002172option smtpchk X - X X
2173option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2174option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2175option splice-request (*) X X X X
2176option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002177option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002178option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2179option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2180-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002181option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002182option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2183option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2184option tcpka X X X X
2185option tcplog X X X X
2186option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002187external-check command X - X X
2188external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002189persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2190rate-limit sessions X X X -
2191redirect - X X X
2192redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2193redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2194reqadd - X X X
2195reqallow - X X X
2196reqdel - X X X
2197reqdeny - X X X
2198reqiallow - X X X
2199reqidel - X X X
2200reqideny - X X X
2201reqipass - X X X
2202reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002203reqitarpit - X X X
2204reqpass - X X X
2205reqrep - X X X
2206-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002207reqtarpit - X X X
2208retries X - X X
2209rspadd - X X X
2210rspdel - X X X
2211rspdeny - X X X
2212rspidel - X X X
2213rspideny - X X X
2214rspirep - X X X
2215rsprep - X X X
2216server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002217server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002218server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002219source X - X X
2220srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002221stats admin - X X X
2222stats auth X X X X
2223stats enable X X X X
2224stats hide-version X X X X
2225stats http-request - X X X
2226stats realm X X X X
2227stats refresh X X X X
2228stats scope X X X X
2229stats show-desc X X X X
2230stats show-legends X X X X
2231stats show-node X X X X
2232stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002233-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2234stick match - - X X
2235stick on - - X X
2236stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002237stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002238stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002239tcp-check connect - - X X
2240tcp-check expect - - X X
2241tcp-check send - - X X
2242tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002243tcp-request connection - X X -
2244tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002245tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002246tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002247tcp-response content - - X X
2248tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002249timeout check X - X X
2250timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002251timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002252timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2253timeout connect X - X X
2254timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2255timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2256timeout http-request X X X X
2257timeout queue X - X X
2258timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002259timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002260timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2261timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002262timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002263transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002264unique-id-format X X X -
2265unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002266use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002267use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002268------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2269 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002270
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022724.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2273---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002274
2275This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2276
2277
2278acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2279 Declare or complete an access list.
2280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2281 no | yes | yes | yes
2282 Example:
2283 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2284 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2285 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002287 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002288
2289
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002290appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2291 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002292 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2294 no | no | yes | yes
2295 Arguments :
2296 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2297 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2298
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002299 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002300 checked in each cookie value.
2301
2302 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2303 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2304 milliseconds.
2305
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002306 request-learn
2307 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2308 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2309 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2310 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2311 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2312 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2313
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002314 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2315 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2316 data following this prefix.
2317
2318 Example :
2319 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2320
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002321 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2322 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002323
2324 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2325 2 modes are currently supported :
2326 - path-parameters :
2327 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2328 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2329 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2330 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2331 - query-string :
2332 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2333 query string.
2334
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002335 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2336 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2337 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002338
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002339 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2340 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002341
2342
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002343backlog <conns>
2344 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2346 yes | yes | yes | no
2347 Arguments :
2348 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2349 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002350 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002351
2352 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2353 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2354 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2355 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2356 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2357 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2358 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2359 backlog parameter.
2360
2361 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2362 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2363 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2364
2365 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2366
2367
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002368balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002369balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002370 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2372 yes | no | yes | yes
2373 Arguments :
2374 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2375 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2376 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2377 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2378
2379 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2380 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2381 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2382 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002383 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002384 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002385 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2386 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2387 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2388 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2389 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2390 it, so that you don't worry.
2391
2392 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2393 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2394 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2395 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2396 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2397 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2398 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2399 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002400
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002401 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2402 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2403 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2404 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2405 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2406 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2407 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2408 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2409
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002410 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002411 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002412 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2413 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002414 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002415 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2416 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2417 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2418 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2419 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002420 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2421 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2422 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2423 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2424 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2425 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002426
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002427 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2428 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2429 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2430 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2431 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2432 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2433 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2434 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002435 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002436 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002437 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2438 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2439 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002440
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002441 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2442 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2443 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2444 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2445 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2446 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2447 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2448 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2449 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2450 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2451 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2452 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002453
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002454 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002455 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2456 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2457 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2458 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2459 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2460 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2461 URIs start with a leading "/".
2462
2463 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2464 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2465 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2466 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2467
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002468 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002469 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2470
2471 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002472 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2473 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002474 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2475 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2476 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2477 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002478 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002479 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2480 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002481
2482 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2483 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2484 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2485 server will receive the request.
2486
2487 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2488 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2489 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2490 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2491 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002492 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2493 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2494 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002495
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002496 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2497 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2498 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2499 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2500 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002501
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002502 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002503 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2504 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2505 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2506
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002507 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2508 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2509 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2510
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002511 random A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
2512 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2513 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2514 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2515 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
2516 or removed. The hash-balance-factor directive can be used to
2517 further improve fairness of the load balancing, especially
2518 in situations where servers show highly variable response
2519 times.
2520
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002521 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002522 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002523 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2524 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2525 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2526 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2527 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2528 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002529 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002530 used instead.
2531
2532 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2533 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2534 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2535 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2536
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002537 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2538 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2539 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2540
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002541 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002542
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002543 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002544 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2545 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002546
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002547 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2548 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2549 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002550
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002551 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2552 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2553 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2554 NTLM relies on.
2555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002556 Examples :
2557 balance roundrobin
2558 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002559 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002560 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2561 balance hdr(host)
2562 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002563
2564 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2565 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2566
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002567 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002568 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2569 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2570 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2571 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2572
2573 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2574 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2575 defaults to 16 kB.
2576
2577 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2578 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2579
2580 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2581 Round Robin.
2582
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002583 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002584 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2585 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2586 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2587
2588 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2589
2590 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002591 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002592 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2593 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2594 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002595
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002596 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002597
2598
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002599bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2600bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002601 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2603 no | yes | yes | no
2604 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002605 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2606 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2607 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2608 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002609 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002610 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2611 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2612 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2613 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2614 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2615 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2616 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002617 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2618 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2619 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2620 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2621 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2622 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2623 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002624 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2625 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2626 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002627 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2628 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2629 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2630 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002631 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2632 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2633 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002634
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002635 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2636 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002637 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2638 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2639 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002640 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2641 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2642 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2643 the range.
2644
2645 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2646 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2647 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2648 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2649 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2650 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2651 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002652 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002653 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002654
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002655 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002656 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002657 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2658 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2659 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2660 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2661 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2662 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2663
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002664 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2665 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2666 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2667 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002668
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002669 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2670 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2671 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2672 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2673 in a frontend.
2674
2675 Example :
2676 listen http_proxy
2677 bind :80,:443
2678 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002679 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002680
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002681 listen http_https_proxy
2682 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002683 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002684
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002685 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2686 bind ipv6@:80
2687 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2688 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2689
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002690 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002691 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002692
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002693 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2694 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2695 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2696 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2697 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2698
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002699 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002700 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002701
2702
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002703bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002704 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2706 yes | yes | yes | yes
2707 Arguments :
2708 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2709 may be used to override a default value.
2710
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002711 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002712 option may be combined with other numbers.
2713
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002714 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002715 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2716 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2717 missing from all processes.
2718
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002719 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002720 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002721 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2722 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2723 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2724 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2725 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002726 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002727
2728 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2729 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2730 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2731 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2732 and 'even' instances.
2733
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002734 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2735 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2736 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2737 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002738
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002739 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2740 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2741
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002742 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2743 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2744 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2745
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002746 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2747 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2748
2749 Example :
2750 listen app_ip1
2751 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002752 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002753
2754 listen app_ip2
2755 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002756 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002757
2758 listen management
2759 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002760 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002761
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002762 listen management
2763 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2764 bind-process 1-4
2765
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002766 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002767
2768
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002769block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002770 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2772 no | yes | yes | yes
2773
2774 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2775 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002776 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002777 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002778 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002779 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2780 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2781 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002782
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002783 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2784 "http-request deny" instead.
2785
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002786 Example:
2787 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2788 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2789 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002790 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2791 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2792 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002793
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002794 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2795 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2796 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002797
2798capture cookie <name> len <length>
2799 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2801 no | yes | yes | no
2802 Arguments :
2803 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2804 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2805 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2806 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002807 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002808
2809 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2810 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2811 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2812 right if it exceeds <length>.
2813
2814 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2815 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2816 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2817 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2818
2819 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2820 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2821 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2822
2823 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2824 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2825 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002826 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2827 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2828 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002829
2830 Example:
2831 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2832
2833 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002834 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002835
2836
2837capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002838 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2840 no | yes | yes | no
2841 Arguments :
2842 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002843 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002844 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2845 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2846 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2847
2848 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2849 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2850 it exceeds <length>.
2851
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002852 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002853 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2854 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002855 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2856 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2857 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2858 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002859 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002860 environments to find where the request came from.
2861
2862 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2863 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2864 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2865 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002866
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002867 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2868 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2869 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2870 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2871 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002872
2873 Example:
2874 capture request header Host len 15
2875 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002876 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002877
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002878 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002879 about logging.
2880
2881
2882capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002883 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2885 no | yes | yes | no
2886 Arguments :
2887 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002888 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002889 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2890 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2891 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2892
2893 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2894 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2895 it exceeds <length>.
2896
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002897 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002898 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2899 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2900 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002901 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2902 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2903 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2904 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002905
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002906 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2907 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2908 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2909 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2910 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002911
2912 Example:
2913 capture response header Content-length len 9
2914 capture response header Location len 15
2915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002916 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002917 about logging.
2918
2919
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002920clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002921 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2923 yes | yes | yes | no
2924 Arguments :
2925 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2926 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2927 as explained at the top of this document.
2928
2929 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2930 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2931 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2932 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2933 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2934 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2935 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2936 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002937 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002938 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002939 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002940
2941 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2942 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2943 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2944 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2945 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2946 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2947
2948 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2949 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2950
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002951 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2952 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002953
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002954compression algo <algorithm> ...
2955compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002956compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002957 Enable HTTP compression.
2958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2959 yes | yes | yes | yes
2960 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002961 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2962 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2963 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2964
2965 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002966 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2967 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2968 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002969
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002970 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002971 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002972
2973 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2974 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2975 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2976 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2977 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002978 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002979
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002980 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2981 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2982 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2983 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2984 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2985 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2986 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002987 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002988
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002989 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002990 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002991 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2992 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2993 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2994 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2995 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002996
2997 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2998 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2999 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3000 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3001 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003002 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3003 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3004 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3005 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3006 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003007 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3008 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003009
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003010 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003011 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3012 "Accept-Encoding" header
3013 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01003014 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01003015 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
3016 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003017 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3018 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3019 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3020 "multipart"
3021 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3022 header
3023 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3024 and later
3025 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3026 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003027
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003028 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
3029 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003030
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003031 Examples :
3032 compression algo gzip
3033 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003034
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003035
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003036contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003037 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3039 yes | no | yes | yes
3040 Arguments :
3041 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3042 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3043 as explained at the top of this document.
3044
3045 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003046 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003047 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003048 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003049 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3050 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3051 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3052
3053 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3054 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3055 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3056 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3057 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3058 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3059
3060 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3061 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3062 instead.
3063
3064 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3065 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3066
3067
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003068cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003069 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3070 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003071 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003072 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3074 yes | no | yes | yes
3075 Arguments :
3076 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3077 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3078 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3079 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3080 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3081 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003082 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003083 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3084 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3085
3086 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3087 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3088 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3089 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3090 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3091 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003092 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3093 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003094 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003095 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3096 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003097
3098 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003099 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003100
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003101 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003102 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3103 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003104 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003105 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3106 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3107 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3108 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3109 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3110 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3111 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003112
3113 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3114 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3115 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3116 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3117 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3118 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3119 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3120 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3121 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003122 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003123 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3124 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3125 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003126
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003127 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3128 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3129 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003130 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3131 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3132 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3133 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003134 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3135 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3136 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003137
3138 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3139 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3140 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3141 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3142 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3143 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3144 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3145 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3146 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3147
3148 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3149 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3150 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3151 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3152 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3153 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3154 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3155 persistence cookie in the cache.
3156 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3157
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003158 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3159 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3160 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3161 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3162 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003163 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003164 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3165 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3166 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3167 they logout.
3168
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003169 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3170 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3171 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3172 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3173
3174 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3175 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3176 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3177 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3178 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3179 this attribute.
3180
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003181 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003182 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003183 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3184 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3185 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3186 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3187 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3188 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003189
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003190 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3191 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3192 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3193 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3194 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3195 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3196 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3197 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003198 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003199 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3200 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3201 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3202 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3203 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3204 the site.
3205
3206 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3207 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3208 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3209 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3210 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3211 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3212 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3213 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3214 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3215 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3216 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3217 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3218 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003219 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003220 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3221 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3222
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003223 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3224 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3225 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3226 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3227 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3228 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3229
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003230 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3231 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3232 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3233 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003234
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003235 Examples :
3236 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3237 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3238 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003239 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003240
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003241 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003242
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003243
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003244declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3245 Declares a capture slot.
3246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3247 no | yes | yes | no
3248 Arguments:
3249 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3250
3251 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3252 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3253 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3254 for use in the response.
3255
3256 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003257 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003258 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3259
3260
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003261default-server [param*]
3262 Change default options for a server in a backend
3263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3264 yes | no | yes | yes
3265 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003266 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3267 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3268 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3269 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003270
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003271 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003272 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3273
3274 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003275
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003276
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003277default_backend <backend>
3278 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3280 yes | yes | yes | no
3281 Arguments :
3282 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3283
3284 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3285 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3286 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3287 will catch all undetermined requests.
3288
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003289 Example :
3290
3291 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3292 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3293 default_backend dynamic
3294
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003295 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003296
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003297
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003298description <string>
3299 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3301 no | yes | yes | yes
3302 Arguments : string
3303
3304 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3305 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3306 it describes.
3307 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3308
3309
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003310disabled
3311 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3313 yes | yes | yes | yes
3314 Arguments : none
3315
3316 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3317 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3318 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3319 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3320 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3321 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3322 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3323
3324 See also : "enabled"
3325
3326
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003327dispatch <address>:<port>
3328 Set a default server address
3329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3330 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003331 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003332
3333 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3334 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3335 during start-up.
3336
3337 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3338 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3339 possible with normal servers.
3340
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003341 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003342 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3343 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3344 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3345 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3346
3347 See also : "server"
3348
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003349
3350dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3351 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3353 yes | no | yes | yes
3354 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3355
3356 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003357 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003358 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3359 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003360 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003361 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003362
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003363enabled
3364 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3366 yes | yes | yes | yes
3367 Arguments : none
3368
3369 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3370 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3371
3372 See also : "disabled"
3373
3374
3375errorfile <code> <file>
3376 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3378 yes | yes | yes | yes
3379 Arguments :
3380 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003381 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3382 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003383
3384 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003385 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003386 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003387 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3388 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003389
3390 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3391 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3392 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3393
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003394 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3395
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003396 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3397 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3398 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3399 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3400
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003401 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3402 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003403 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003404 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3405 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3406 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3407
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003408 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3409 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3410 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003411 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003412 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3413
3414 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3415
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003416 Example :
3417 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003418 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003419 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3420 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3421
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003422
3423errorloc <code> <url>
3424errorloc302 <code> <url>
3425 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3427 yes | yes | yes | yes
3428 Arguments :
3429 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003430 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3431 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003432
3433 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3434 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3435 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3436 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003437 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003438
3439 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3440 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3441 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3442
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003443 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3444
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003445 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3446 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3447 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3448 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003449 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003450 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3451 request.
3452
3453 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3454
3455
3456errorloc303 <code> <url>
3457 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3459 yes | yes | yes | yes
3460 Arguments :
3461 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003462 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3463 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003464
3465 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3466 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3467 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3468 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003469 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003470
3471 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3472 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3473 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3474
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003475 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3476
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003477 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3478 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3479 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3480 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003481 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003482
3483 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3484
3485
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003486email-alert from <emailaddr>
3487 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003488 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003489 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3490 yes | yes | yes | yes
3491
3492 Arguments :
3493
3494 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3495
3496 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3497 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3498
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003499 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003500 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3501 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003502
3503
3504email-alert level <level>
3505 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3506 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3507 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3508 yes | yes | yes | yes
3509
3510 Arguments :
3511
3512 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3513 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3514 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3515
3516 By default level is alert
3517
3518 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3519 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3520 for the proxy.
3521
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003522 Alerts are sent when :
3523
3524 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3525 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3526 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3527 is notice or lower
3528 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3529 and a health check status update occurs
3530
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003531 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3532 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003533 section 3.6 about mailers.
3534
3535
3536email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3537 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3538 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3539 yes | yes | yes | yes
3540
3541 Arguments :
3542
3543 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3544
3545 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3546 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3547
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003548 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3549 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003550
3551
3552email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3553 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3554 mailers.
3555 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3556 yes | yes | yes | yes
3557
3558 Arguments :
3559
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003560 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003561
3562 By default the systems hostname is used.
3563
3564 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3565 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3566 for the proxy.
3567
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003568 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3569 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003570
3571
3572email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003573 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003574 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3575 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3576 yes | yes | yes | yes
3577
3578 Arguments :
3579
3580 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3581
3582 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3583 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3584
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003585 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003586 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3587
3588
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003589force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3590 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3591 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003592 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003593
3594 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3595 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3596 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3597 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3598 marked down for maintenance operations.
3599
3600 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3601 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3602 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3603 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3604 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3605 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3606 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3607 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3608 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3609
3610 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3611 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3612 is used.
3613
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003614 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003615 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003616
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003617
3618filter <name> [param*]
3619 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3621 no | yes | yes | yes
3622 Arguments :
3623 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3624 referenced in section 9.
3625
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003626 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003627 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003628 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3629 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003630
3631 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3632 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3633
3634 Example:
3635 listen
3636 bind *:80
3637
3638 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3639 filter compression
3640 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3641
3642 compression algo gzip
3643 compression offload
3644
3645 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3646
3647 See also : section 9.
3648
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003649
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003650fullconn <conns>
3651 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3653 yes | no | yes | yes
3654 Arguments :
3655 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3656 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3657
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003658 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003659 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003660 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003661 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3662 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3663 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3664 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3665 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003666 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003667
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003668 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3669 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003670 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3671 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3672 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003673
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003674 Example :
3675 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3676 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3677 # connections.
3678 backend dynamic
3679 fullconn 10000
3680 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3681 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3682
3683 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3684
3685
3686grace <time>
3687 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003689 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003690 Arguments :
3691 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3692 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3693 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3694
3695 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3696 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003697 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003698 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3699
3700 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3701 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3702 simplify it.
3703
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003704
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003705hash-balance-factor <factor>
3706 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3708 yes | no | no | yes
3709 Arguments :
3710 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3711 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3712 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3713
3714 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3715 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3716 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3717 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3718 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3719 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3720 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3721
3722 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3723 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3724 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3725 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3726 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3727
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003728 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3729 consistent hashing mechanism.
3730
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003731 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3732
3733
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003734hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003735 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3737 yes | no | yes | yes
3738 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003739 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3740 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003741
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003742 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3743 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3744 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3745 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3746 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3747 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3748 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3749 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3750 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3751 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003752
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003753 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3754 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3755 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3756 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3757 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3758 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3759 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3760 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3761 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3762 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3763 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3764 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3765 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003766 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3767 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003768
3769 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3770
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003771 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003772 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3773 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3774 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003775 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3776 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3777 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003778
3779 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3780 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003781 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3782 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3783 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3784 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3785
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003786 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3787 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3788 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3789 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3790 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3791 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3792 parameter.
3793
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003794 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3795 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3796 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3797 used on strings.
3798
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003799 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3800
3801 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3802 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3803 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3804 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3805 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3806 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3807 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3808 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3809 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3810 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3811 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3812 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003813
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003814 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3815 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3816 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003817
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003818 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003819
3820
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003821http-check disable-on-404
3822 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003824 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003825 Arguments : none
3826
3827 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3828 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3829 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3830 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3831 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3832 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3833 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3834 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003835 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3836 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3837 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3838
3839 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3840
3841
3842http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003843 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003845 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003846 Arguments :
3847 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3848 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003849 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003850 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3851 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3852 details on the supported keywords.
3853
3854 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3855 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3856 with the usual backslash ('\').
3857
3858 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3859 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3860 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3861 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3862 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3863
3864 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003865 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003866 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3867 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3868 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3869
3870 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003871 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003872 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3873 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3874 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3875 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3876
3877 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003878 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003879 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3880 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3881 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3882 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3883 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003884 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003885 trace).
3886
3887 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003888 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003889 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3890 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3891 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3892 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3893 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003894 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003895
3896 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3897 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3898 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3899 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3900 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3901 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3902 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3903 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3904
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003905 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3906 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3907 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3908
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003909 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3910 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3911
3912 Examples :
3913 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003914 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003915
3916 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003917 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003918
3919 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003920 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003921
3922 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003923 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003924
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003925 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003926
3927
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003928http-check send-state
3929 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3931 yes | no | yes | yes
3932 Arguments : none
3933
3934 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3935 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3936 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3937 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3938 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3939
3940 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3941 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3942 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3943 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3944 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003945 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3946 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3947 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3948
3949 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3950 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3951 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3952
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003953 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3954 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3955 checked in multiple backends.
3956
3957 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3958 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3959
3960 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3961 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3962 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3963 one fails.
3964
3965 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3966 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3967 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3968
3969 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3970 server's queue.
3971
3972 Example of a header received by the application server :
3973 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3974 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3975
3976 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3977
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02003978
3979http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003980 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3981
3982 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3983 no | yes | yes | yes
3984
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003985 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3986 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3987 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3988 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3989 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003990
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02003991 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
3992 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003993
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02003994 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003995
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02003996 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3997 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3998 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
3999 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004000
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004001 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4002 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4003 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4004 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004005
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004006 Example:
4007 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4008 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4009 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004010
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004011 http-request allow if nagios
4012 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4013 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4014 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004015
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004016 Example:
4017 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4018 acl add path /addacl
4019 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004020
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004021 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004022
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004023 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4024 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004025
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004026 Example:
4027 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4028 acl setmap path /setmap
4029 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004030
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004031 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004032
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004033 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4034 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004035
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004036 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4037 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004038
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004039http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004040
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004041 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4042 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4043 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4044 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4045 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4046 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4047 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4048 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004049
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004050http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004051
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004052 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4053 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4054 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4055 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4056 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4057 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4058 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4059 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004060
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004061http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004062
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004063 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4064 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004065
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004066
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004067http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004068
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004069 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4070 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4071 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4072 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4073 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004074
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004075 Example:
4076 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4077 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004078
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004079http-request cache-use [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004080
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004081 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004082
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004083http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4084 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004085
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004086 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4087 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4088 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4089 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4090 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4091 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4092 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4093 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4094 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004095
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004096 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4097 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4098 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4099 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4100 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4101 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004102
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004103http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004104
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004105 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4106 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4107 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4108 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4109 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4110 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004112http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004113
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004114 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004115
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004116http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004117
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004118 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4119 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4120 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4121 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4122 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4123 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004124
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004125http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004126
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004127 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4128 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4129 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4130 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4131 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004132
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004133http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004134
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004135 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4136 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4137 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4138 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4139 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004140
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004141http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004142
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004143 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4144 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4145 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4146 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004147
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004148http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4149 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004150
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004151 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4152 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4153 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4154 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4155 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4156 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4157 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4158 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004159
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004160 Example:
4161 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004162
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004163 # applied to:
4164 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004165
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004166 # outputs:
4167 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004168
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004169 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004170
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004171http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4172 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004173
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004174 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4175 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4176 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4177 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004178
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004179 Example:
4180 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004181
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004182 # applied to:
4183 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004184
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004185 # outputs:
4186 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004187
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004188http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4189http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004190
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004191 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4192 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4193 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004194
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004195http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004196
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004197 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4198 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4199 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004200
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004201http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004202
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004203 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4204 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4205 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4206 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4207 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004208
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004209 Arguments:
4210 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4211 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004212
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004213 Example:
4214 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4215 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004216
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004217 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4218 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004219
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004220http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004221
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004222 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4223 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4224 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004225
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004226 Arguments:
4227 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4228 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004229
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004230 Example:
4231 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4232 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004233
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004234 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4235 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4236 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004237
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004238http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004239
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004240 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4241 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4242 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4243 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4244 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004245
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004246 Example:
4247 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4248 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4249 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4250 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4251 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4252 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4253 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4254 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4255 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004256
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004257http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004258
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004259 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4260 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4261 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4262 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4263 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004264
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004265http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4266 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004267
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004268 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4269 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4270 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4271 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4272 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4273 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4274 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4275 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4276 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004278http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004279
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004280 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4281 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4282 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4283 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4284 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4285 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4286 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004287
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004288http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004289
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004290 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4291 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4292 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004293
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004294http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004295
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004296 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4297 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4298 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4299 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4300 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4301 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4302 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4303 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004304
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004305http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004306
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004307 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4308 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4309 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4310 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4311 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4312 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004313
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004314 Example :
4315 # prepend the host name before the path
4316 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004317
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004318http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004319
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004320 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4321 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4322 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4323 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4324 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004325
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004326http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004327
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004328 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4329 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4330 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4331 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4332 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4333 values have higher priority.
4334 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4335 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4336 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4337 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4338 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004342 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4343 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4344 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4345 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4346 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4347 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4348 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004349
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004350 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004351
4352 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004353 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4354 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004356http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4357 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4358 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4359 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4360 privacy.
4361
4362 Arguments :
4363 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4364 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004365
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004366 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004367 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4368 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4369
4370 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4371 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4372
4373http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4374
4375 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4376 expression.
4377
4378 Arguments:
4379 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4380 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004381
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004382 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004383 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4384 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4385
4386 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4387 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4388 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4389
4390http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4391
4392 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4393 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4394 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4395 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4396 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4397 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4398 information from the request.
4399
4400 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4401
4402http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4403
4404 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4405 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4406 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4407 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4408 path and the query string.
4409 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4410
4411http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4412
4413 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4414 inline.
4415
4416 Arguments:
4417 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4418 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4419 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4420 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4421 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4422 (request and response)
4423 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4424 processing
4425 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4426 processing
4427 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4428 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4429 and '_'.
4430
4431 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4432 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004433
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004434 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004435 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004436
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004437http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4438 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004439
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004440 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4441 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4442 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4443 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4444 agent name must be used.
4445
4446 Arguments:
4447 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4448
4449 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4450 configuration.
4451
4452http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4453
4454 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4455 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4456 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4457 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4458 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4459 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4460 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4461 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4462 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4463 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4464 action.
4465 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4466 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4467 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4468 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4469 you fully understand how it works.
4470
4471http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4472
4473 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4474 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4475 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4476 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4477 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4478 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4479 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4480 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4481 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4482 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4483 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4484 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4485 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4486
4487http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4488http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4489http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4490
4491 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4492 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4493 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4494 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4495 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4496 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4497 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4498 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4499 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4500 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4501 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4502 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4503
4504 Arguments :
4505 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4506 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4507 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4508 select which table entry to update the counters.
4509
4510 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4511 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4512 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4513 that table until the session ends.
4514
4515 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4516 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4517 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4518 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4519 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4520 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4521 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4522 useful information.
4523
4524 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4525 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4526 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4527 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4528 checks that make use of it.
4529
4530http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4531
4532 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004533
4534 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004535 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004536
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004537http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004538
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004539 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4540 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4541 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004542
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004543
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004544http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004545 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4546
4547 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4548 no | yes | yes | yes
4549
4550 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4551 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4552 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4553 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4554 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4555 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4556
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004557 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4558 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004559
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004560 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004561
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004562 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4563 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4564 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4565 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004566
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004567 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4568 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4569 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4570 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004571
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004572 Example:
4573 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004574
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004575 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004576
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004577 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4578 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004579
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004580 Example:
4581 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004582
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004583 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004584
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004585 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4586 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004587
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004588 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4589 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004590
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004591http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004592
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004593 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4594 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4595 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4596 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4597 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4598 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4599 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4600 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004601
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004602http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004603
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004604 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4605 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4606 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4607 example, or to pass some internal information.
4608 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4609 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4610 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004611
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004612http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004613
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004614 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4615 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004616
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004617http-response cache-store [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004618
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004619 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004620
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004621http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004622
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004623 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4624 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4625 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4626 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4627 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4628 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4629 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004630
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004631 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4632 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4633 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4634 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4635 keyword.
4636 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4637 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004638
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004639http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004640
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004641 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4642 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4643 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4644 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4645 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4646 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004647
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004648http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004649
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004650 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004651
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004652http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004653
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004654 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4655 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4656 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4657 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4658 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4659 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004660
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004661http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004662
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004663 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4664 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004665
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004666http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004667
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004668 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4669 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4670 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4671 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4672 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4673 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004674
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004675http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4676 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004677
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004678 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4679 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4680 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4681 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4682 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4683 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4684 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4685 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004686
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004687 Example:
4688 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004689
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004690 # applied to:
4691 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004692
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004693 # outputs:
4694 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004695
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004696 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004697
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004698http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4699 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004700
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004701 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4702 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4703 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4704 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004705
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004706 Example:
4707 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004708
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004709 # applied to:
4710 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004711
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004712 # outputs:
4713 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004714
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004715http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4716http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004717
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004718 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4719 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4720 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004721
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004722http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004723
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004724 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4725 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4726 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004727
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004728http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004729
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004730 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4731 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4732 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4733 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4734 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004735
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004736 Arguments:
4737 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004738
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004739 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4740 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004741
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004742http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004743
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004744 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4745 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4746 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004747
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004748http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4749
4750 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4751 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4752 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4753 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4754 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4755
4756http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4757
4758 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4759 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4760 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4761 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4762 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4763 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4764 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4765 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4766 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4767
4768http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4769
4770 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4771 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4772 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4773 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
4774 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
4775 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
4776 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
4777
4778http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4779
4780 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4781 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4782 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4783 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4784 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
4785 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4786 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4787 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4788
4789http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4790 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4791
4792 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4793 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4794 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4795 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004796
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004797 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004798 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4799 http-response set-status 431
4800 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4801 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004802
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004803http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004804
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004805 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4806 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4807 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4808 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
4809 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
4810 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
4811 based on some information from the request.
4812
4813 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4814
4815http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4816
4817 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4818 inline.
4819
4820 Arguments:
4821 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4822 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4823 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4824 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4825 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4826 (request and response)
4827 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4828 processing
4829 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4830 processing
4831 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4832 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4833 and '_'.
4834
4835 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4836 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004837
4838 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004839 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004840
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004841http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004842
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004843 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4844 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4845 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4846 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4847 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4848 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4849 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4850 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4851 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4852 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4853 action.
4854 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4855 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4856 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4857 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4858 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004859
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004860http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4861http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4862http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004863
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004864 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
4865 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4866 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
4867 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
4868 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
4869 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4870
4871http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4872
4873 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
4874 about <var-name>.
4875
4876 Example:
4877 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4878
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004879
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004880http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4881 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4882
4883 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4884 yes | no | yes | yes
4885
4886 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4887 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4888 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4889 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4890 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004891 This directive allows to tune this behavior.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004892
4893 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4894
4895 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4896 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4897 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4898 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4899 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4900 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4901 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4902 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4903 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4904 not checking any request past the first one.
4905
4906 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4907 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4908 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4909 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4910 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4911 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4912 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4913
4914 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4915 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4916 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4917 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4918 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4919 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4920 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4921 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4922 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4923 downsides of rare connection failures.
4924
4925 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4926 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4927 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4928 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4929 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4930 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004931 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004932 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4933 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4934 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4935 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4936 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4937
4938 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004939 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
4940 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
4941 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004942
4943 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004944 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004945
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02004946 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
4947 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004948
4949 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4950 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4951 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4952
4953 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4954 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4955 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4956
4957 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4958
4959
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004960http-send-name-header [<header>]
4961 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4962
4963 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4964 yes | no | yes | yes
4965
4966 Arguments :
4967
4968 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4969
4970 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004971 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004972 is added with the header string proved.
4973
4974 See also : "server"
4975
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004976id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004977 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4979 no | yes | yes | yes
4980 Arguments : none
4981
4982 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4983 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4984 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004985
4986
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004987ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4988 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4989 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004990 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004991
4992 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4993 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4994 and running).
4995
4996 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4997 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4998 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004999 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005000 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5001
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005002 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5003 "unless" condition is met.
5004
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005005 Example:
5006 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5007 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5008 ignore-persist if url_static
5009
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005010 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5011
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005012load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5013 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5014 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5015 yes | no | yes | yes
5016
5017 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5018 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5019 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005020 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005021 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5022 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5023 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5024 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5025
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005026 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005027 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005028 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005029
5030 Arguments:
5031 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5032 named "server-state-file".
5033
5034 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5035 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5036 name is used as a file name.
5037
5038 none don't load any stat for this backend
5039
5040 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005041 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5042 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5043 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005044 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005045 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005046
5047 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5048 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5049
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005050 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005051
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005052 global
5053 stats socket /tmp/socket
5054 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005055
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005056 defaults
5057 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005058
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005059 backend bk
5060 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5061 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005062
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005063
5064 Then one can run :
5065
5066 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5067
5068 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5069
5070 1
5071 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5072 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5073 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5074
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005075 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005076
5077 global
5078 stats socket /tmp/socket
5079 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5080
5081 defaults
5082 load-server-state-from-file local
5083
5084 backend bk
5085 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5086 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5087
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005088
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005089 Then one can run :
5090
5091 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5092
5093 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5094
5095 1
5096 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5097 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5098 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5099
5100 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5101 "show servers state"
5102
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005103
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005104log global
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005105log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005106no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005107 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5109 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005110
5111 Prefix :
5112 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5113 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5114 prefix does not allow arguments.
5115
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005116 Arguments :
5117 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5118 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5119 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5120 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5121 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5122 parameter.
5123
5124 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5125 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5126
5127 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5128 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5129 standard syslog port).
5130
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005131 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5132 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5133 standard syslog port).
5134
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005135 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5136 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5137 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005138 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005139
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005140 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5141 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5142 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5143 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5144 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5145 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5146 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5147 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5148 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5149 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5150 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5151 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5152 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5153 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5154 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5155 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005156 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5157 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005158
5159 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5160 and "fd@2", see above.
5161
5162 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5163 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005164
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005165 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5166 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5167 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5168 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5169 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5170 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5171 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5172 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5173 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5174 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005175 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005176
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005177 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5178 one of the following :
5179
5180 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5181 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5182
5183 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5184 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5185
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005186 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5187 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5188 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5189 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5190 systemd logger consumes.
5191
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005192 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5193 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5194 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5195 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5196
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005197 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5198
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005199 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5200 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5201 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5202
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005203 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5204 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5205 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5206 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005207
5208 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5209 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5210 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005211 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5212 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5213 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5214 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5215 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005216
5217 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5218
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005219 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5220 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5221 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005222
5223 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5224 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5225 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5226 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5227
5228 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5229 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005230
5231 Example :
5232 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005233 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5234 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5235 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005236 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5237 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005238 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005239
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005240
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005241log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005242 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5243 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5244 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005245
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005246 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5247 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5248 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5249 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5250 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005251
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005252 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5253 "option httplog" directives.
5254
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005255log-format-sd <string>
5256 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5257 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5258 yes | yes | yes | no
5259
5260 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5261 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5262 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5263 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5264 which covers the log format string in depth.
5265
5266 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5267 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5268
5269 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5270 log format to "rfc5424".
5271
5272 Example :
5273 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5274
5275
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005276log-tag <string>
5277 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5278 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5279 yes | yes | yes | yes
5280
5281 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5282 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5283 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5284 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5285 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5286 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5287 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5288 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5289 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005290
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005291max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5292 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5293 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5294 yes | no | yes | yes
5295
5296 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5297 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5298 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5299 servers.
5300
5301 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5302 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5303 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5304 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5305 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005306 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005307 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5308 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5309 picking a different server.
5310
5311 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5312 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5313 even if they have to be queued.
5314
5315 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5316 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5317
5318
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005319maxconn <conns>
5320 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5322 yes | yes | yes | no
5323 Arguments :
5324 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5325 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5326 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5327 closes.
5328
5329 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5330 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5331 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5332 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005333 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5334 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5335 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5336 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005337
5338 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5339 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5340 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5341
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005342 By default, this value is set to 2000.
5343
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005344 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5345
5346
5347mode { tcp|http|health }
5348 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5350 yes | yes | yes | yes
5351 Arguments :
5352 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5353 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5354 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5355 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5356
5357 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5358 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5359 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5360 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5361 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5362
5363 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005364 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5365 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5366 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5367 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5368 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5369 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5370 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005371
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005372 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5373 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5374 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005375
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005376 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005377 defaults http_instances
5378 mode http
5379
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005380 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005381
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005382
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005383monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005384 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5386 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005387 Arguments :
5388 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5389 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005390 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005391 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5392 backend and its backup.
5393
5394 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5395 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5396 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5397 servers in a list of backends.
5398
5399 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5400 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5401 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5402 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5403 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5404 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5405 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005406 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5407 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005408
5409 Example:
5410 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005411 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005412 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5413 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5414 monitor-uri /site_alive
5415 monitor fail if site_dead
5416
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005417 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005418
5419
5420monitor-net <source>
5421 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5423 yes | yes | yes | no
5424 Arguments :
5425 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5426 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5427 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5428 followed by a mask.
5429
5430 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5431 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005432 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005433 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5434
5435 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5436 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5437 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5438 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005439 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5440 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5441 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005442
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005443 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5444 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5445 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5446 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5447 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5448 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005449
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005450 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5451 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005452
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005453 Example :
5454 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5455 frontend www
5456 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5457
5458 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5459
5460
5461monitor-uri <uri>
5462 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5464 yes | yes | yes | no
5465 Arguments :
5466 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5467 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5468
5469 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5470 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5471 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5472 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5473 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5474 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5475 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5476 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5477
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005478 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5479 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5480 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5481 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5482 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5483 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5484 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5485 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005486
5487 Example :
5488 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5489 frontend www
5490 mode http
5491 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5492
5493 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5494
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005495
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005496option abortonclose
5497no option abortonclose
5498 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5500 yes | no | yes | yes
5501 Arguments : none
5502
5503 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5504 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5505 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5506 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005507 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005508 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5509 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5510 encountered while delivering the response.
5511
5512 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5513 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5514 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5515 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5516 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5517 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005518 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005519 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005520 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005521 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5522 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5523 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5524
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005525 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5526 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005527 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5528 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5529 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5530 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5531 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5532 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005533 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005534
5535 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5536 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5537
5538 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5539
5540
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005541option accept-invalid-http-request
5542no option accept-invalid-http-request
5543 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5545 yes | yes | yes | no
5546 Arguments : none
5547
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005548 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005549 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005550 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005551 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5552 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5553 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5554 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5555 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005556 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5557 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5558 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5559 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005560 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005561 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005562 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5563 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5564 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005565
5566 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5567 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5568 been confirmed.
5569
5570 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5571 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005572 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5573 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005574 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5575
5576 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5577 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5578
5579 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5580 stats socket.
5581
5582
5583option accept-invalid-http-response
5584no option accept-invalid-http-response
5585 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5587 yes | no | yes | yes
5588 Arguments : none
5589
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005590 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005591 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005592 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005593 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5594 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5595 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5596 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5597 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005598 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5599 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5600 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005601
5602 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5603 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5604 been confirmed.
5605
5606 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5607 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5608 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5609 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5610
5611 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5612 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5613
5614 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5615 stats socket.
5616
5617
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005618option allbackups
5619no option allbackups
5620 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5622 yes | no | yes | yes
5623 Arguments : none
5624
5625 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5626 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5627 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5628 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5629 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5630 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5631 order between the backup servers anymore.
5632
5633 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5634 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5635
5636 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5637 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5638
5639
5640option checkcache
5641no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005642 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5644 yes | no | yes | yes
5645 Arguments : none
5646
5647 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5648 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005649 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005650 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5651 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005652 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005653
5654 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005655 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005656 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005657 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5658 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005659 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005660 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005661 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5662 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005663 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005664 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5665 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005666 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005667 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5668 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5669 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5670 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5671 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5672 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5673 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5674 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5675 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5676
5677 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005678 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005679 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005680 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005681 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5682
5683 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5684 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005685 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005686 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005687
5688 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5689 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5690
5691
5692option clitcpka
5693no option clitcpka
5694 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5696 yes | yes | yes | no
5697 Arguments : none
5698
5699 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5700 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005701 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005702 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5703
5704 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5705 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5706 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5707 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5708
5709 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5710 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5711 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5712 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5713 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5714
5715 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5716
5717 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5718 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5719 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5720
5721 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5722 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5723
5724 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5725
5726
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005727option contstats
5728 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5730 yes | yes | yes | no
5731 Arguments : none
5732
5733 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5734 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5735 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5736 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005737 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5738 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5739 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5740 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5741 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005742
5743
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005744option dontlog-normal
5745no option dontlog-normal
5746 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5748 yes | yes | yes | no
5749 Arguments : none
5750
5751 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5752 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5753 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5754 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5755 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5756 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5757 logged.
5758
5759 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5760 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5761 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5762
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005763 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005764 logging.
5765
5766
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005767option dontlognull
5768no option dontlognull
5769 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5771 yes | yes | yes | no
5772 Arguments : none
5773
5774 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5775 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5776 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5777 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5778 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5779 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005780 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5781 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5782 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005783
5784 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005785 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005786 would not be logged.
5787
5788 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5789 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5790
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005791 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5792 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005793
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005794
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005795option forceclose (deprecated)
5796no option forceclose (deprecated)
5797 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005798
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005799 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005800
5801
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005802option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005803 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5805 yes | yes | yes | yes
5806 Arguments :
5807 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5808 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005809 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005810 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005811
5812 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5813 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5814 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5815 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5816 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5817 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5818 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005819 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5820 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5821 possible that the client has already brought one.
5822
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005823 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005824 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005825 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005826 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005827 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005828 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005829
5830 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5831 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5832 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5833 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5834 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5835 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5836 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5837
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005838 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5839 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5840 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5841 are under the control of the end-user.
5842
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005843 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005844 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5845 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005846 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5847 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5848 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005849
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005850 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005851 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5852 frontend www
5853 mode http
5854 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5855
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005856 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5857 backend www
5858 mode http
5859 option forwardfor header X-Client
5860
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005861 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005862 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005863
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005864
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005865option http-buffer-request
5866no option http-buffer-request
5867 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5869 yes | yes | yes | yes
5870 Arguments : none
5871
5872 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5873 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5874 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5875 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5876 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5877 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5878 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5879 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005880 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005881 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5882 default.
5883
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005884 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005885
5886
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005887option http-ignore-probes
5888no option http-ignore-probes
5889 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5891 yes | yes | yes | no
5892 Arguments : none
5893
5894 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5895 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5896 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5897 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5898 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5899 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5900 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5901 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5902 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005903 was received over a connection before it was closed;
5904 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005905 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5906
5907 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5908 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5909 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5910 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5911 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5912 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5913 are often the only way to detect them.
5914
5915 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5916 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5917
5918 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5919
5920
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005921option http-keep-alive
5922no option http-keep-alive
5923 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5925 yes | yes | yes | yes
5926 Arguments : none
5927
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005928 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5929 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005930 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5931 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5932 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
5933 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
5934 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005935
5936 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5937 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005938 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5939 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5940 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5941 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5942 situations where this option may be useful :
5943
5944 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005945 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005946
5947 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5948 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5949
5950 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5951 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5952 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5953 request.
5954
5955 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5956 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005957 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5958 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5959 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005960
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005961 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5962 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5963 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5964 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5965 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5966 not set.
5967
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005968 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005969 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
5970 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005971
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005972 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005973 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005974 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005975
5976
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005977option http-no-delay
5978no option http-no-delay
5979 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5981 yes | yes | yes | yes
5982 Arguments : none
5983
5984 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5985 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5986 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5987 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5988 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5989 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5990 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5991 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5992 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5993 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5994 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5995 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5996 affected.
5997
5998 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5999 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6000 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6001 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6002 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6003 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6004 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6005 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6006 latency environments.
6007
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006008 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6009
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006010
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006011option http-pretend-keepalive
6012no option http-pretend-keepalive
6013 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006015 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006016 Arguments : none
6017
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006018 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006019 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6020 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6021 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6022 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6023 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6024 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6025 consider the response complete.
6026
6027 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6028 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6029 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6030 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006031 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006032 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6033
6034 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6035 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6036 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6037 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6038 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6039 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6040 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6041
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006042 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6043 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6044 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6045 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6046 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6047 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006048
6049 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6050 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6051
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006052 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006053 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006054
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006055
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006056option http-server-close
6057no option http-server-close
6058 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6060 yes | yes | yes | yes
6061 Arguments : none
6062
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006063 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6064 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6065 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6066 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006067 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6068 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6069 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6070 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6071 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6072 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6073 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6074 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6075 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6076 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6077 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006078
6079 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6080 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6081 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6082 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006083 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6084 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006085
6086 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6087 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006088 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6089 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6090 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006091
6092 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6093 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6094
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006095 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6096 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006097
6098
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006099option http-tunnel
6100no option http-tunnel
6101 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
6102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006103 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006104 Arguments : none
6105
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006106 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6107 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6108 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6109 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006110 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006111
6112 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006113 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006114 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6115 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6116 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6117 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6118 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6119 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6120 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006121
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006122 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6123 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6124 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6125 backend.
6126
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006127 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6128 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6129
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006130 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6131 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006132
6133
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006134option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006135no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006136 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6138 yes | yes | yes | no
6139 Arguments : none
6140
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006141 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006142 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6143 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6144 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6145 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6146 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6147 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6148
6149 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6150 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006151 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6152 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6153 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006154
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006155 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6156 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6157 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6158 front of an existing proxy.
6159
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006160 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6161
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006162 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006163
6164
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006165option http-use-htx
6166no option http-use-htx
6167 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6169 yes | yes | yes | yes
6170 Arguments : none
6171
6172 By default, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
6173 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
6174 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. Since this principle has deep
6175 roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being
6176 processed this way. It also results in the inability to establish HTTP/2
6177 connections to servers because of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1
6178 representation.
6179
6180 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6181 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6182 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6183 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
6184 most elements are directly accessed. This mechanism is still limited to the
6185 most basic operations (no compression, filters, Lua, applets, cache, etc).
6186 But it supports using either HTTP/1 or HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the
6187 other side's version.
6188
6189 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. It will cause errors to be
6190 emitted if incompatible features are used, but will allow H2 to be selected
6191 as a server protocol. It is recommended to use this option on new reasonably
6192 simple configurations, but since the feature still has incomplete functional
6193 coverage, it is not enabled by default.
6194
6195 See also : "mode http"
6196
6197
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006198option httpchk
6199option httpchk <uri>
6200option httpchk <method> <uri>
6201option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6202 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6204 yes | no | yes | yes
6205 Arguments :
6206 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6207 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6208 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6209 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6210 ones.
6211
6212 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6213 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6214 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6215
6216 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6217 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6218 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6219 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6220 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6221
6222 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6223 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6224 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6225 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6226 the lack of any response.
6227
6228 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6229
6230 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6231 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6232 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6233
6234 Examples :
6235 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6236 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6237 backend https_relay
6238 mode tcp
6239 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6240 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6241
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006242 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6243 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6244 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006245
6246
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006247option httpclose
6248no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006249 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6251 yes | yes | yes | yes
6252 Arguments : none
6253
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006254 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6255 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6256 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6257 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006258 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006259
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006260 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6261 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6262 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6263 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6264 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006265
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006266 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6267 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6268 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006269
6270 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6271 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006272 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006273 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6274 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6275 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006276
6277 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6278 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6279
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006280 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006281
6282
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006283option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006284 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006286 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006287 Arguments :
6288 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6289 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6290 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006291 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006292 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006293
6294 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6295 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6296 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6297 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6298 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6299 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6300 ports.
6301
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006302 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6303 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006304
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006305 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6306
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006307 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006308
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006309
6310option http_proxy
6311no option http_proxy
6312 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6314 yes | yes | yes | yes
6315 Arguments : none
6316
6317 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6318 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6319 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6320 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6321 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6322
6323 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6324 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006325 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6326 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006327
6328 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6329 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6330
6331 Example :
6332 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6333 backend direct_forward
6334 option httpclose
6335 option http_proxy
6336
6337 See also : "option httpclose"
6338
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006339
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006340option independent-streams
6341no option independent-streams
6342 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6344 yes | yes | yes | yes
6345 Arguments : none
6346
6347 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6348 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6349 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6350 receive data or not.
6351
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006352 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006353 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6354 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6355 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6356 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6357 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6358 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6359 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6360 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6361 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6362 socket buffers.
6363
6364 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6365 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6366 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6367 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6368 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6369
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006370 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006371 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6372 deprecated.
6373
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006374 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006375
6376
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006377option ldap-check
6378 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6380 yes | no | yes | yes
6381 Arguments : none
6382
6383 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6384 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6385 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6386 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6387
6388 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6389 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6390
6391 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6392 configure it.
6393
6394 Example :
6395 option ldap-check
6396
6397 See also : "option httpchk"
6398
6399
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006400option external-check
6401 Use external processes for server health checks
6402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6403 yes | no | yes | yes
6404
6405 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6406 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6407 command".
6408
6409 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6410
6411 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6412
6413
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006414option log-health-checks
6415no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006416 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6418 yes | no | yes | yes
6419 Arguments : none
6420
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006421 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6422 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6423 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006424
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006425 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6426 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6427 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6428 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6429 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6430
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006431 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006432 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006433
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006434 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6435 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6436 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006437
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006438
6439option log-separate-errors
6440no option log-separate-errors
6441 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6443 yes | yes | yes | no
6444 Arguments : none
6445
6446 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6447 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6448 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6449 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6450 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6451 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6452 provides very important information.
6453
6454 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6455 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6456 error logs.
6457
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006458 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006459 logging.
6460
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006461
6462option logasap
6463no option logasap
6464 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6466 yes | yes | yes | no
6467 Arguments : none
6468
6469 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6470 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6471 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6472 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6473 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6474 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6475 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006476 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006477 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6478 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6479
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006480 Examples :
6481 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6482 mode http
6483 option httplog
6484 option logasap
6485 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6486
6487 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6488 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6489 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6490 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6491
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006492 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006493 logging.
6494
6495
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006496option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006497 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6499 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006500 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006501 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6502 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006503 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006504
6505 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6506 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006507 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006508 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6509 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6510 in the MySQL table, like this :
6511
6512 USE mysql;
6513 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6514 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6515
6516 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006517 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006518 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6519 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6520 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6521 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6522 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6523 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6524 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6525
6526 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6527 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006528
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006529 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006530
6531 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6532 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6533 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6534 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006535 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6536 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006537
6538 See also: "option httpchk"
6539
6540
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006541option nolinger
6542no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006543 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006544 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6545 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006546 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006547
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006548 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006549 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6550 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6551 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6552 connections.
6553
6554 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6555 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6556 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6557 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6558 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6559 this too.
6560
6561 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6562 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6563 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6564
6565 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6566 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6567 for servers.
6568
6569 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6570 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6571
6572
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006573option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6574 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6576 yes | yes | yes | yes
6577 Arguments :
6578 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6579 matching <network>
6580 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6581 header name.
6582
6583 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6584 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6585 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6586 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6587 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6588 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6589 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6590 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6591 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6592 possible that the client has already brought one.
6593
6594 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6595 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6596 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6597 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6598 header and requires different one.
6599
6600 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6601 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6602 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6603 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6604 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6605 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6606 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6607
6608 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6609 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6610 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6611 both are defined.
6612
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006613 Examples :
6614 # Original Destination address
6615 frontend www
6616 mode http
6617 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6618
6619 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6620 backend www
6621 mode http
6622 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6623
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006624 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006625
6626
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006627option persist
6628no option persist
6629 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6630 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6631 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006632 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006633
6634 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6635 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6636 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6637 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6638 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6639 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6640 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6641 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6642 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6643 redirected to another valid server.
6644
6645 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6646 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6647
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006648 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006649
6650
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006651option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6652 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6654 yes | no | yes | yes
6655 Arguments :
6656 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6657 PostgreSQL server.
6658
6659 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6660 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6661 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6662 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6663
6664 See also: "option httpchk"
6665
6666
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006667option prefer-last-server
6668no option prefer-last-server
6669 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6670 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6671 yes | no | yes | yes
6672 Arguments : none
6673
6674 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6675 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6676 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6677 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6678 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6679 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6680 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6681 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6682 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006683 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6684 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006685 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6686 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6687 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006688 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6689 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6690 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006691
6692 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6693 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6694
6695 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6696
6697
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006698option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006699option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006700no option redispatch
6701 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6702 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6703 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006704 Arguments :
6705 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6706 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6707 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006708 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006709 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006710 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006711 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6712 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6713 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6714
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006715
6716 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6717 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6718 be able to access the service anymore.
6719
6720 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6721 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6722
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006723 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006724 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6725 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006726
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006727 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6728 "redisp" keywords.
6729
6730 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6731 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6732
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006733 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006734
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006735
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006736option redis-check
6737 Use redis health checks for server testing
6738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6739 yes | no | yes | yes
6740 Arguments : none
6741
6742 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6743 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6744 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6745 find the "+PONG" response message.
6746
6747 Example :
6748 option redis-check
6749
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006750 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006751
6752
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006753option smtpchk
6754option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6755 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6757 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006758 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006759 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006760 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006761 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6762
6763 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6764 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6765 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6766
6767 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6768 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6769 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6770 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6771 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6772 dead server.
6773
6774 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6775 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006776 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006777 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6778
6779 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6780 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6781 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6782 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006783 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006784
6785 Example :
6786 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6787
6788 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6789
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006790
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006791option socket-stats
6792no option socket-stats
6793
6794 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6796 yes | yes | yes | no
6797
6798 Arguments : none
6799
6800
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006801option splice-auto
6802no option splice-auto
6803 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6805 yes | yes | yes | yes
6806 Arguments : none
6807
6808 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6809 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006810 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006811 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006812 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006813 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6814 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6815 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6816 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6817
6818 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6819 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6820 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6821 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6822 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6823 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6824 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6825 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6826 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6827 keyword.
6828
6829 Example :
6830 option splice-auto
6831
6832 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6833 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6834
6835 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6836 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6837
6838
6839option splice-request
6840no option splice-request
6841 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6843 yes | yes | yes | yes
6844 Arguments : none
6845
6846 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006847 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006848 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6849 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6850 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6851 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6852
6853 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6854
6855 Example :
6856 option splice-request
6857
6858 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6859 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6860
6861 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6862 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6863
6864
6865option splice-response
6866no option splice-response
6867 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6869 yes | yes | yes | yes
6870 Arguments : none
6871
6872 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006873 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006874 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6875 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6876 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6877 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6878
6879 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6880
6881 Example :
6882 option splice-response
6883
6884 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6885 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6886
6887 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6888 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6889
6890
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006891option spop-check
6892 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6894 no | no | no | yes
6895 Arguments : none
6896
6897 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6898 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6899 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6900 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6901
6902 Example :
6903 option spop-check
6904
6905 See also : "option httpchk"
6906
6907
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006908option srvtcpka
6909no option srvtcpka
6910 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6912 yes | no | yes | yes
6913 Arguments : none
6914
6915 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6916 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006917 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006918 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6919
6920 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6921 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6922 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6923 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6924
6925 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6926 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6927 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6928 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6929 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6930
6931 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6932
6933 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6934 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6935 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6936
6937 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6938 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6939
6940 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6941
6942
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006943option ssl-hello-chk
6944 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6946 yes | no | yes | yes
6947 Arguments : none
6948
6949 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6950 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6951 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6952 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6953 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6954 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6955 hello message.
6956
6957 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6958 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6959 messages, which is appreciable.
6960
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006961 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6962 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6963 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006964
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006965 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6966
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006967
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006968option tcp-check
6969 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6970 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6971 yes | no | yes | yes
6972
6973 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6974 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6975
6976 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6977 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6978 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6979
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006980 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006981 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6982 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6983 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6984 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6985 only.
6986
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006987 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006988 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6989 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6990 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6991 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6992
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006993 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006994 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
6995 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006996 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006997 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6998 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6999 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7000 the respective protocols.
7001 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007002 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007003
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007004 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7005 script.
7006
7007 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7008 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7009 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7010 The "comment" is of course optional.
7011
7012
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007013 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007014 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007015 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007016 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007017
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007018 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007019 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007020 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007021
7022 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7023 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007024 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007025 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007026 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007027 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007028 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007029 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007030 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7031 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007032 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007033 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7034 tcp-check expect string +OK
7035
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007036 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007037 (send many headers before analyzing)
7038 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007039 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007040 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7041 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7042 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7043 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007044 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007045
7046
7047 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7048
7049
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007050option tcp-smart-accept
7051no option tcp-smart-accept
7052 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7054 yes | yes | yes | no
7055 Arguments : none
7056
7057 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7058 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7059 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7060 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7061 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7062 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7063
7064 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7065 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7066 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7067 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7068
7069 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7070 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7071 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007072 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007073
7074 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7075 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7076 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7077
7078 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7079 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7080 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7081
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007082 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7083
7084
7085option tcp-smart-connect
7086no option tcp-smart-connect
7087 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7089 yes | no | yes | yes
7090 Arguments : none
7091
7092 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7093 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7094 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7095 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7096 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7097
7098 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7099 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7100 complex.
7101
7102 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7103 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7104 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7105
7106 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7107 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7108
7109 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7110
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007111
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007112option tcpka
7113 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7115 yes | yes | yes | yes
7116 Arguments : none
7117
7118 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7119 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007120 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007121 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7122
7123 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7124 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7125 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7126 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7127
7128 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7129 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7130 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7131 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7132 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7133
7134 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7135
7136 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7137 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7138 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7139 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7140 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7141 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7142 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7143 backends.
7144
7145 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7146
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007147
7148option tcplog
7149 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007151 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007152 Arguments : none
7153
7154 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7155 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7156 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7157 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7158 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7159 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7160 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7161 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7162
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007163 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007165 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007166
7167
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007168option transparent
7169no option transparent
7170 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007172 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007173 Arguments : none
7174
7175 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7176 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7177 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7178 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7179 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7180 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7181 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7182 appropriate server.
7183
7184 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7185 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7186
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007187 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007188 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007189
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007190
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007191external-check command <command>
7192 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7194 yes | no | yes | yes
7195
7196 Arguments :
7197 <command> is the external command to run
7198
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007199 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7200
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007201 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007202
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007203 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7204 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7205 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7206 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7207 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7208 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007209
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007210 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7211
7212 Environment variables :
7213 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7214 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7215
7216 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7217
7218 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7219
7220 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7221 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7222 for a UNIX socket).
7223
7224 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7225
7226 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7227
7228 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7229
7230 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7231
7232 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7233
7234 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7235 socket).
7236
7237 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7238 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7239
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007240 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7241 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7242 failed.
7243
7244 Example :
7245 external-check command /bin/true
7246
7247 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7248
7249
7250external-check path <path>
7251 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7253 yes | no | yes | yes
7254
7255 Arguments :
7256 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7257
7258 The default path is "".
7259
7260 Example :
7261 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7262
7263 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7264 "external-check command"
7265
7266
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007267persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007268persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007269 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7271 yes | no | yes | yes
7272 Arguments :
7273 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007274 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7275 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007276
7277 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7278 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007279 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007280 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7281 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7282 forwarded to this server.
7283
7284 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7285 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7286 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007287 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007288 a single "listen" section.
7289
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007290 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7291 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7292 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7293
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007294 Example :
7295 listen tse-farm
7296 bind :3389
7297 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7298 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7299 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7300 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7301 persist rdp-cookie
7302 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007303 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007304 balance rdp-cookie
7305 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7306 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7307
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007308 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7309 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007310
7311
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007312rate-limit sessions <rate>
7313 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7315 yes | yes | yes | no
7316 Arguments :
7317 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7318 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7319
7320 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7321 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7322 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7323 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7324 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7325 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7326
7327 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7328 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7329 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7330 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7331
7332 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7333 listen smtp
7334 mode tcp
7335 bind :25
7336 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007337 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007338
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007339 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7340 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7341 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007342
7343 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7344
7345
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007346redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7347redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7348redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007349 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7351 no | yes | yes | yes
7352
7353 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007354 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007355
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007356 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007357 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007358 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7359 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7360 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007361
7362 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7363 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7364 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7365 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7366 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007367 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7368 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7369 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7370 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007371
7372 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7373 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7374 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7375 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7376 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7377 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007378 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007379 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007380 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7381 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7382 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007383
7384 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007385 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7386 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7387 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007388 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007389 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7390 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7391 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7392 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007393
7394 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007395 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007396
7397 - "drop-query"
7398 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7399 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7400 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7401 with a location-type redirect.
7402
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007403 - "append-slash"
7404 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7405 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7406 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7407 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7408
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007409 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7410 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7411 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7412 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7413 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7414 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7415 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7416
7417 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7418 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7419 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7420 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7421 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7422 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7423 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007424
7425 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7426 acl clear dst_port 80
7427 acl secure dst_port 8080
7428 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007429 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007430 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007431 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7432
7433 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007434 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7435 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7436 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007437 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007438
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007439 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7440 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7441 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7442
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007443 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007444 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007445
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007446 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007447 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7448 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7449 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007450
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007451 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007452
7453
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007454redisp (deprecated)
7455redispatch (deprecated)
7456 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7457 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7458 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007459 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007460
7461 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7462 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7463 be able to access the service anymore.
7464
7465 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7466 redistribute them to a working server.
7467
7468 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7469 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7470 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007471
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007472 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7473 "option redispatch" instead.
7474
7475 See also : "option redispatch"
7476
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007477
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007478reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007479 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7481 no | yes | yes | yes
7482 Arguments :
7483 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7484 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007485 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007486
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007487 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7488 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7489
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007490 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7491 the last header of an HTTP request.
7492
7493 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7494 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7495 responses.
7496
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007497 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7498 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7499 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7500
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007501 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7502 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007503
7504
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007505reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7506reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007507 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7509 no | yes | yes | yes
7510 Arguments :
7511 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7512 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7513 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7514 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7515 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7516 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7517 ignores case.
7518
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007519 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7520 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7521
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007522 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7523 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7524 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7525 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007526 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007527
7528 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7529 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7530
7531 Example :
7532 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7533 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7534 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7535
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007536 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7537 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007538
7539
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007540reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7541reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007542 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7544 no | yes | yes | yes
7545 Arguments :
7546 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7547 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7548 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7549 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7550 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7551 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7552
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007553 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7554 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7555
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007556 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7557 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7558 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7559 next servers.
7560
7561 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7562 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7563 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7564
7565 Example :
7566 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7567 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7568 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7569
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007570 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7571 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007572
7573
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007574reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7575reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007576 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7578 no | yes | yes | yes
7579 Arguments :
7580 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7581 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7582 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7583 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7584 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7585 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7586 case.
7587
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007588 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7589 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7590
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007591 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7592 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7593 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7594 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007595 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007596
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007597 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007598 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007599 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007600
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007601 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7602 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7603
7604 Example :
7605 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7606 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7607 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7608
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007609 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7610 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007611
7612
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007613reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7614reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007615 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7617 no | yes | yes | yes
7618 Arguments :
7619 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7620 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7621 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7622 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7623 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7624 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7625 case.
7626
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007627 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7628 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7629
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007630 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7631 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7632 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7633 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7634
7635 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7636 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7637
7638 Example :
7639 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7640 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7641 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7642 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7643
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007644 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7645 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007646
7647
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007648reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7649reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007650 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7652 no | yes | yes | yes
7653 Arguments :
7654 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7655 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7656 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7657 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7658 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7659 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7660
7661 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7662 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7663 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7664 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007665 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007666
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007667 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7668 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7669
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007670 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7671 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7672 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7673
7674 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7675 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7676 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7677 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7678 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7679
7680 Example :
7681 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007682 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007683 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7684 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7685
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007686 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7687 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007688
7689
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007690reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7691reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007692 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7694 no | yes | yes | yes
7695 Arguments :
7696 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7697 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7698 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7699 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7700 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7701 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7702 ignores case.
7703
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007704 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7705 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7706
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007707 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7708 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007709 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7710 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7711 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007712 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7713 not set.
7714
7715 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7716 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7717 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7718 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7719 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7720
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007721 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007722 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007723 # block all others.
7724 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7725 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7726
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007727 # block bad guys
7728 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7729 reqitarpit . if badguys
7730
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007731 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7732 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007733
7734
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007735retries <value>
7736 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7737 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7738 yes | no | yes | yes
7739 Arguments :
7740 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7741 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7742 default value is 3.
7743
7744 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7745 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7746 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7747
7748 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007749 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7750 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007751
7752 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7753 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7754
7755 See also : "option redispatch"
7756
7757
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007758rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007759 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7761 no | yes | yes | yes
7762 Arguments :
7763 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7764 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007765 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007766
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007767 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7768 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7769
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007770 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7771 the last header of an HTTP response.
7772
7773 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7774 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7775 responses.
7776
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007777 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7778 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007779
7780
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007781rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7782rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007783 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7785 no | yes | yes | yes
7786 Arguments :
7787 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7788 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7789 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7790 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7791 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7792 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7793 ignores case.
7794
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007795 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7796 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7797
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007798 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7799 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007800 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007801 client.
7802
7803 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7804 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7805 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7806
7807 Example :
7808 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007809 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007810
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007811 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7812 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007813
7814
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007815rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7816rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007817 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7819 no | yes | yes | yes
7820 Arguments :
7821 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7822 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7823 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7824 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7825 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7826 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7827 ignores case.
7828
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007829 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7830 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7831
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007832 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7833 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7834 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7835 case-sensitive.
7836
7837 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007838 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7839 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7840 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007841
7842 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7843 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7844
7845 Example :
7846 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7847 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7848
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007849 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7850 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007851
7852
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007853rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7854rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007855 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7857 no | yes | yes | yes
7858 Arguments :
7859 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7860 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7861 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7862 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7863 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7864 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7865 ignores case.
7866
7867 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7868 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7869 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7870 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007871 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007872
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007873 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7874 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7875
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007876 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7877 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7878 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7879
7880 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7881 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7882 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7883 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7884 are not case-sensitive.
7885
7886 Example :
7887 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7888 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7889
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007890 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7891 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007892
7893
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007894server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007895 Declare a server in a backend
7896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7897 no | no | yes | yes
7898 Arguments :
7899 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007900 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007901 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007902
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007903 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7904 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7905 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7906 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007907 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7908 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7909 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7910 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7911 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007912 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7913 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7914 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7915 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7916 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7917 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7918 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007919 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007920 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7921 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7922 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7923 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7924 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
7925 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007926 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7927 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007928 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7929 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007930
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007931 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007932 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7933 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7934 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7935 adding this value to the client's port.
7936
7937 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7938 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007939 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007940
7941 Examples :
7942 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7943 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007944 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007945 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7946 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7947 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007948
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007949 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7950 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7951 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7952 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7953 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7954
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007955 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7956 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007957
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007958server-state-file-name [<file>]
7959 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7960 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7961 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7962 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7963 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7964 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7965
7966 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7967 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7968
7969 global
7970 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7971
7972 backend bk
7973 load-server-state-from-file
7974
7975 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7976 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007977
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007978server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7979 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7980 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7982 no | no | yes | yes
7983
7984 Arguments:
7985 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7986
7987 <num | range>
7988 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7989 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7990 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7991 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7992
7993 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7994
7995 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7996
7997 <params*>
7998 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7999 keyword.
8000
8001 Examples:
8002 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8003 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8004 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8005
8006 # or
8007 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8008
8009 # would be equivalent to:
8010 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8011 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8012 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8013
8014
8015
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008016source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008017source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008018source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008019 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8021 yes | no | yes | yes
8022 Arguments :
8023 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8024 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008025
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008026 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008027 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8028 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8029 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8030 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8031 supported prefixes are :
8032 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8033 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8034 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008035 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008036 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8037 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008038
8039 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8040 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008041 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8042 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8043 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008044
8045 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8046 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8047 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8048 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8049 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8050 <addr>.
8051
8052 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8053 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8054 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8055 port.
8056
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008057 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8058 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8059 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8060 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008061 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008062 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8063 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8064 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8065 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8066 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8067 HTTP header.
8068
8069 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8070 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008071 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008072 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8073 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8074 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8075 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8076 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8077 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8078 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8079
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008080 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8081 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8082 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8083 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8084 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8085 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8086
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008087 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8088 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8089 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8090 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8091
8092 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8093 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8094 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8095 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8096 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8097 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8098
8099 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8100 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8101 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8102 there are two methods :
8103
8104 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8105 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8106 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8107 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8108 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8109 of the client ranges may be used.
8110
8111 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8112 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8113 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8114 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8115 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8116 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8117 same session.
8118
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008119 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8120 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8121 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008122 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008123
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008124 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8125
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008126 Examples :
8127 backend private
8128 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8129 source 192.168.1.200
8130
8131 backend transparent_ssl1
8132 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8133 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8134
8135 backend transparent_ssl2
8136 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8137 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8138 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8139
8140 backend transparent_ssl3
8141 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8142 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8143 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8144
8145 backend transparent_smtp
8146 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8147 # with Tproxy version 4.
8148 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8149
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008150 backend transparent_http
8151 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8152 # proxy.
8153 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8154
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008155 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008156 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8157
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008158
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008159srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8160 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8162 yes | no | yes | yes
8163 Arguments :
8164 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8165 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8166 as explained at the top of this document.
8167
8168 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8169 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8170 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8171 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8172 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8173 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8174 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8175
8176 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8177 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8178 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8179 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8180 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008181 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008182 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008183 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008184
8185 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8186 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8187 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8188 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8189 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8190 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8191
8192 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8193 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8194
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008195 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8196 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008197
8198
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008199stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8200 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008202 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008203
8204 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8205 matched.
8206
8207 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8208 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8209
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008210 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8211 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008212 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008213
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008214 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8215 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8216 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8217 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008218
8219 Example :
8220 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8221 backend stats_localhost
8222 stats enable
8223 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8224
8225 Example :
8226 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8227 backend stats_auth
8228 stats enable
8229 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8230 stats admin if TRUE
8231
8232 Example :
8233 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8234 userlist stats-auth
8235 group admin users admin
8236 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8237 group readonly users haproxy
8238 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8239
8240 backend stats_auth
8241 stats enable
8242 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8243 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8244 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8245 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8246
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008247 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8248 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8249 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008250
8251
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008252stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8253 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008255 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008256 Arguments :
8257 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8258
8259 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8260
8261 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8262 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8263 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8264 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8265 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8266 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8267
8268 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8269 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8270 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008271 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008272
8273 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8274 report using "stats scope".
8275
8276 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8277 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8278 unobvious parameters.
8279
8280 Example :
8281 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8282 backend public_www
8283 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8284 stats enable
8285 stats hide-version
8286 stats scope .
8287 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008288 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008289 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8290 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8291
8292 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8293 backend private_monitoring
8294 stats enable
8295 stats uri /admin?stats
8296 stats refresh 5s
8297
8298 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8299
8300
8301stats enable
8302 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008304 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008305 Arguments : none
8306
8307 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8308 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8309 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8310 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8311 - stats auth : no authentication
8312 - stats scope : no restriction
8313
8314 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8315 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8316 unobvious parameters.
8317
8318 Example :
8319 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8320 backend public_www
8321 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8322 stats enable
8323 stats hide-version
8324 stats scope .
8325 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008326 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008327 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8328 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8329
8330 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8331 backend private_monitoring
8332 stats enable
8333 stats uri /admin?stats
8334 stats refresh 5s
8335
8336 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8337
8338
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008339stats hide-version
8340 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008342 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008343 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008344
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008345 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8346 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8347 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8348 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8349 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8350 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008351
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008352 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8353 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8354 unobvious parameters.
8355
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008356 Example :
8357 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8358 backend public_www
8359 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008360 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008361 stats hide-version
8362 stats scope .
8363 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008364 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008365 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8366 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008367
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008368 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8369 backend private_monitoring
8370 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008371 stats uri /admin?stats
8372 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008373
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008374 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008375
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008376
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008377stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8378 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8379 Access control for statistics
8380
8381 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8382 no | no | yes | yes
8383
8384 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8385 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8386 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8387 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8388 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8389 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8390
8391 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8392 instance.
8393
8394 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8395 about ACL usage.
8396
8397
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008398stats realm <realm>
8399 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008401 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008402 Arguments :
8403 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8404 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8405 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8406
8407 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8408 using a backslash ('\').
8409
8410 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8411 only related to authentication.
8412
8413 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8414 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8415 unobvious parameters.
8416
8417 Example :
8418 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8419 backend public_www
8420 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8421 stats enable
8422 stats hide-version
8423 stats scope .
8424 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008425 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008426 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8427 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8428
8429 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8430 backend private_monitoring
8431 stats enable
8432 stats uri /admin?stats
8433 stats refresh 5s
8434
8435 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8436
8437
8438stats refresh <delay>
8439 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008441 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008442 Arguments :
8443 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8444 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8445 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8446 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8447 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8448 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8449
8450 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8451 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8452 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8453 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8454
8455 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8456 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8457 unobvious parameters.
8458
8459 Example :
8460 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8461 backend public_www
8462 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8463 stats enable
8464 stats hide-version
8465 stats scope .
8466 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008467 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008468 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8469 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8470
8471 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8472 backend private_monitoring
8473 stats enable
8474 stats uri /admin?stats
8475 stats refresh 5s
8476
8477 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8478
8479
8480stats scope { <name> | "." }
8481 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008483 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008484 Arguments :
8485 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8486 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8487 section in which the statement appears.
8488
8489 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8490 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8491 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8492 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8493 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8494 exists.
8495
8496 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8497 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8498 unobvious parameters.
8499
8500 Example :
8501 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8502 backend public_www
8503 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8504 stats enable
8505 stats hide-version
8506 stats scope .
8507 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008508 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008509 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8510 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8511
8512 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8513 backend private_monitoring
8514 stats enable
8515 stats uri /admin?stats
8516 stats refresh 5s
8517
8518 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8519
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008520
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008521stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008522 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008524 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008525
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008526 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008527 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8528
8529 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8530 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8531
8532 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8533 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008534 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008535
8536 Example :
8537 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8538 backend private_monitoring
8539 stats enable
8540 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8541 stats uri /admin?stats
8542 stats refresh 5s
8543
8544 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8545 global section.
8546
8547
8548stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008549 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8551 yes | yes | yes | yes
8552 Arguments : none
8553
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008554 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008555 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8556 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8557 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8558 - IP (socket, server)
8559 - cookie (backend, server)
8560
8561 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8562 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008563 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008564
8565 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8566
8567
8568stats show-node [ <name> ]
8569 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008571 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008572 Arguments:
8573 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8574 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8575
8576 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8577 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008578 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008579
8580 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8581 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8582 unobvious parameters.
8583
8584 Example:
8585 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8586 backend private_monitoring
8587 stats enable
8588 stats show-node Europe-1
8589 stats uri /admin?stats
8590 stats refresh 5s
8591
8592 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8593 section.
8594
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008595
8596stats uri <prefix>
8597 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008599 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008600 Arguments :
8601 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8602 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8603 query string.
8604
8605 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8606 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8607 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8608 possible to reach it in the application.
8609
8610 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008611 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008612 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8613 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8614 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8615 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8616
8617 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8618 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8619 an address or a port to statistics only.
8620
8621 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8622 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8623 unobvious parameters.
8624
8625 Example :
8626 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8627 backend public_www
8628 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8629 stats enable
8630 stats hide-version
8631 stats scope .
8632 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008633 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008634 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8635 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8636
8637 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8638 backend private_monitoring
8639 stats enable
8640 stats uri /admin?stats
8641 stats refresh 5s
8642
8643 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8644
8645
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008646stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8647 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008649 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008650
8651 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008652 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008653 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008654 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008655 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8656
8657 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8658 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8659 the "stick-table" statement.
8660
8661 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8662 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8663 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8664 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8665 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8666
8667 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8668 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8669 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8670 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8671 transformation rules.
8672
8673 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8674 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8675 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8676 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8677 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8678 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8679 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8680
8681 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8682 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8683 ACL based conditions.
8684
8685 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8686 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8687 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8688 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8689
8690 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8691 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8692 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8693 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8694
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008695 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8696 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008697 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008698
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008699 Example :
8700 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8701 # last 30 minutes
8702 backend pop
8703 mode tcp
8704 balance roundrobin
8705 stick store-request src
8706 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8707 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8708 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8709
8710 backend smtp
8711 mode tcp
8712 balance roundrobin
8713 stick match src table pop
8714 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8715 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8716
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008717 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008718 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008719
8720
8721stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8722 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8724 no | no | yes | yes
8725
8726 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8727 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8728 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8729 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8730
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008731 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8732 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008733 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008734
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008735 Examples :
8736 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008737 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008738
8739 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8740 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8741 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8742
8743
8744 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8745 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8746 backend http
8747 mode http
8748 balance roundrobin
8749 stick on src table https
8750 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8751 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8752 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8753
8754 backend https
8755 mode tcp
8756 balance roundrobin
8757 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8758 stick on src
8759 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8760 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8761
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008762 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008763
8764
8765stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8766 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8768 no | no | yes | yes
8769
8770 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008771 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008772 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008773 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008774 server is selected.
8775
8776 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8777 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8778 the "stick-table" statement.
8779
8780 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8781 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8782 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8783 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8784 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8785 address.
8786
8787 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8788 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8789 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8790 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8791 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8792 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8793 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8794 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8795 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8796 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8797
8798 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8799 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8800 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8801 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8802 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8803 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8804 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8805
8806 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8807 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8808 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8809 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8810
8811 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8812 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8813 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8814 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8815 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8816 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008817 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8818 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8819 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8820 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8821 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8822 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008823
8824 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8825 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8826 the request.
8827
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008828 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8829 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008830 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008831
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008832 Example :
8833 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8834 # last 30 minutes
8835 backend pop
8836 mode tcp
8837 balance roundrobin
8838 stick store-request src
8839 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8840 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8841 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8842
8843 backend smtp
8844 mode tcp
8845 balance roundrobin
8846 stick match src table pop
8847 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8848 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8849
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008850 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008851 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008852
8853
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008854stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008855 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8856 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008857 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008859 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008860
8861 Arguments :
8862 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8863 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8864 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8865 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8866
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008867 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8868 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8869 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8870 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8871
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008872 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8873 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8874 instance.
8875
8876 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8877 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8878 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8879 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8880 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8881 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008882 to 32 characters.
8883
8884 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8885 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8886 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008887 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008888 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8889 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008890
8891 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008892 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8893 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008894 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8895 increase.
8896
8897 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008898 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8899 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8900 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008901
8902 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8903 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8904 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8905 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008906 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008907 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8908 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8909 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8910 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8911 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8912 parameter (see below).
8913
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008914 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8915 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8916 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8917 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8918 soft restart.
8919
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008920 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8921 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008922
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008923 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8924 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8925 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8926 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008927 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008928 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008929 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8930 if not expiration delay is specified.
8931
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008932 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8933 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8934 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8935 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008936 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8937 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8938 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8939 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8940 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8941 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8942 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8943 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8944 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8945 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8946 types and their arguments.
8947
8948 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8949 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8950 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8951 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8952
8953 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8954 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8955 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008956 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008957
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008958 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8959 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8960 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008961 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008962 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008963 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008964
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008965 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8966 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8967 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8968 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
8969
8970 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
8971 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8972 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8973 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8974 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8975 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
8976
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008977 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8978 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8979 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8980 they were received.
8981
8982 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8983 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8984 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8985 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8986 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8987
8988 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8989 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8990 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8991 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8992 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8993
8994 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8995 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8996 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8997
8998 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8999 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9000 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9001 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9002 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9003
9004 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9005 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9006 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9007 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9008 the client side.
9009
9010 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9011 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9012 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9013 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9014 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9015 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9016 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9017
9018 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9019 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9020 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9021 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9022 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9023 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009024 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009025
9026 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9027 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9028 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9029 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9030 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9031 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9032
9033 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009034 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009035 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9036 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9037
9038 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9039 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9040 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9041 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9042 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9043 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9044 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9045 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9046 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9047 recommended for better fairness.
9048
9049 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009050 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009051 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9052 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9053
9054 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9055 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9056 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9057 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9058 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9059 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9060 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9061 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9062 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9063 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009064
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009065 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9066 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009067 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9068 reference it.
9069
9070 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9071 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009072 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9073 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9074 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009075
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009076 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9077 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9078 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9079 something that can be ignored.
9080
9081 Example:
9082 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9083 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9084 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9085 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9086
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009087 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009088 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009089
9090
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009091stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009092 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9094 no | no | yes | yes
9095
9096 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009097 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009098 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009099 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009100 server is selected.
9101
9102 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9103 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9104 the "stick-table" statement.
9105
9106 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9107 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9108 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9109 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9110
9111 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9112 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9113 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9114 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9115 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9116 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009117 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009118 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9119 rules.
9120
9121 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9122 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9123 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9124 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9125 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9126 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9127 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9128
9129 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9130 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9131 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9132 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9133
9134 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9135 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9136 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9137 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9138 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9139 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009140 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9141 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9142 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9143 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9144 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9145 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9146 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9147 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9148 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009149
9150 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9151
9152 Example :
9153 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9154 backend https
9155 mode tcp
9156 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009157 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009158 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009159
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009160 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9161 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9162
9163 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9164 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9165 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9166
9167 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9168 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009169
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009170 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9171 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9172 # at offset 44.
9173
9174 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9175 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9176
9177 # Learn on response if server hello.
9178 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009179
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009180 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9181 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9182
9183 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9184 extraction.
9185
9186
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009187tcp-check connect [params*]
9188 Opens a new connection
9189 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9190 no | no | yes | yes
9191
9192 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9193 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9194 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9195
9196 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9197 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9198 of the sequence.
9199
9200 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9201 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9202 do.
9203
9204 Parameters :
9205 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9206 use the TCP connection.
9207
9208 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9209 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9210 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9211
9212 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9213
9214 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9215
9216 Examples:
9217 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9218 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9219 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9220 option tcp-check
9221 tcp-check connect
9222 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9223 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9224 tcp-check send \r\n
9225 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9226 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9227 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9228 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9229 tcp-check send \r\n
9230 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9231 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9232
9233 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9234 option tcp-check
9235 tcp-check connect port 110
9236 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9237 tcp-check connect port 143
9238 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9239 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9240
9241 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9242
9243
9244tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009245 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009246 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9247 no | no | yes | yes
9248
9249 Arguments :
9250 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9251 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9252 binary.
9253 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9254 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9255 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9256
9257 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9258 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9259 with the usual backslash ('\').
9260 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009261 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009262 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9263 used upper or lower case.
9264
9265
9266 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9267
9268 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9269 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9270 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9271 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9272 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9273 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9274 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9275 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9276
9277 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9278 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9279 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9280 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9281 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9282 expression.
9283
9284 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9285 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9286 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9287 this exact hexadecimal string.
9288 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9289
9290 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9291 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9292 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9293 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9294 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9295 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9296 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9297 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9298 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9299 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9300 the null character.
9301
9302 Examples :
9303 # perform a POP check
9304 option tcp-check
9305 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9306
9307 # perform an IMAP check
9308 option tcp-check
9309 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9310
9311 # look for the redis master server
9312 option tcp-check
9313 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009314 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009315 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9316 tcp-check expect string role:master
9317 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9318 tcp-check expect string +OK
9319
9320
9321 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9322 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9323
9324
9325tcp-check send <data>
9326 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9327 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9328 no | no | yes | yes
9329
9330 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9331 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9332
9333 Examples :
9334 # look for the redis master server
9335 option tcp-check
9336 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9337 tcp-check expect string role:master
9338
9339 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9340 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9341
9342
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009343tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9344 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009345 tcp health check
9346 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9347 no | no | yes | yes
9348
9349 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9350 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009351 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009352 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9353 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9354 hexadecimal string.
9355 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9356
9357 Examples :
9358 # redis check in binary
9359 option tcp-check
9360 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9361 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9362
9363
9364 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9365 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9366
9367
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009368tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9369 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9371 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009372 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009373 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9374 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009375
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009376 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009377
9378 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9379 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009380 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9381 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9382 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9383 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9384 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9385 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009386
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009387 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9388 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9389 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9390 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009391
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009392 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009393 - accept :
9394 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9395 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9396 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009397
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009398 - reject :
9399 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9400 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9401 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9402 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9403 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9404 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9405 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9406 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9407 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9408 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9409 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009410 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009411
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009412 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9413 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9414 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9415 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9416 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9417 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9418 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9419 hosts.
9420
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009421 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9422 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9423 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9424 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9425 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9426 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9427 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9428 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9429
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009430 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9431 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9432 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9433 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9434 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9435 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9436 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9437 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9438 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009439 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9440 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009441
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009442 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009443 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009444 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9445 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9446 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9447 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9448 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9449 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9450 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9451 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9452 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9453 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9454 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9455 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009456
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009457 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009458 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009459 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009460 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009461 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9462 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9463 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009464
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009465 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9466 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9467 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9468 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009469
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009470 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9471 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9472 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9473 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9474 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009475 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9476 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9477 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9478 layer7 information is extracted.
9479
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009480 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9481 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9482 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9483 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9484 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009485
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009486 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9487 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9488 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9489 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9490
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009491 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9492 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9493 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9494 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9495
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009496 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9497 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9498 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9499 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9500 continues.
9501
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009502 - set-src <expr> :
9503 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9504 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9505 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009506 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009507
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009508 Arguments:
9509 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9510 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009511
9512 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009513 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9514
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009515 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9516 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009517
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009518 - set-src-port <expr> :
9519 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9520 expression.
9521
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009522 Arguments:
9523 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9524 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009525
9526 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009527 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9528
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009529 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9530 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9531 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009532
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009533 - set-dst <expr> :
9534 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9535 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9536 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9537 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9538 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9539
9540 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9541 followed by some converters.
9542
9543 Example:
9544
9545 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9546 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9547
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009548 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9549 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9550
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009551 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9552 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9553 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9554 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9555
9556
9557 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9558 followed by some converters.
9559
9560 Example:
9561
9562 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9563
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009564 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9565 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9566 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9567
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009568 - "silent-drop" :
9569 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009570 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009571 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9572 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9573 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9574 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9575 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009576 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9577 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009578 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9579 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009580 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009581 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9582 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9583 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9584 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9585
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009586 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9587 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9588 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009589
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009590 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9591 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9592 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009593
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009594 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009595 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009596 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009597
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009598 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9599 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9600 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009601
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009602 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009603 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9604 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009605
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009606 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9607
9608 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9609
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009610 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9611
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009612 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009613
9614
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009615tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9616 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009618 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009619 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009620 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9621 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009622
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009623 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009624
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009625 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009626 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9627 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9628 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9629 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009630
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009631 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9632 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9633 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9634 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009635 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9636 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9637 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9638 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9639 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9640 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009641 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009642 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009643
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009644 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9645 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9646 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9647 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009648
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009649 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009650 - accept : the request is accepted
9651 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9652 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009653 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009654 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009655 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009656 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009657 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009658 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009659 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009660 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009661 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009662
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009663 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9664 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009665
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009666 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9667 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9668 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9669 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9670 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9671 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009672
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009673 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009674 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9675 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009676
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009677 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009678 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9679 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9680 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9681 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009682 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9683 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9684 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009685
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009686 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009687 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9688 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9689 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009690
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009691 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009692 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9693 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009694
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009695 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9696 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009697 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009698 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9699 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009700 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009701 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009702 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009703 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9704 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009705 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009706 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9707 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009708
9709 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9710 followed by some converters.
9711
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009712 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9713 <var-name>.
9714
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009715 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9716 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9717 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9718 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9719 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9720
9721 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9722 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9723 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9724 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9725 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9726 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9727 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9728 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9729 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9730 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9731 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9732
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009733 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9734 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9735 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9736 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9737 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9738
9739 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9740
9741 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9742
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009743 Example:
9744
9745 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009746 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009747
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009748 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009749 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9750 # and reject everything else.
9751 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9752 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009753 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009754 tcp-request content reject
9755
9756 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009757 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9758 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9759 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009760 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009761
9762 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9763 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9764 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009765 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009766 tcp-request content reject
9767
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009768 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009769 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009770 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009771 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009772 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9773 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009774
9775 Example:
9776 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9777 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009778 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009779
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009780 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009781 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009782
9783 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009784 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009785 # protecting all our sites
9786 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009787 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9788 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009789 ...
9790 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9791
9792 backend http_dynamic
9793 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009794 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009795 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009796 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009797 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009798 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009799 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009801 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009802
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009803 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9804 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009805
9806
9807tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9808 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009810 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009811 Arguments :
9812 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9813 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9814 as explained at the top of this document.
9815
9816 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9817 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9818 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9819 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9820 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9821
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009822 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9823 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9824 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9825 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9826
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009827 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9828 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009829 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009830 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009831 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9832 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9833 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9834 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009835
9836 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9837 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9838 it pass through unaffected.
9839
9840 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9841 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9842 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009843 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009844 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9845 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009846 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9847 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9848 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009849
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009850 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009851 "timeout client".
9852
9853
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009854tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9855 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9857 no | no | yes | yes
9858 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009859 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9860 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009861
9862 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9863
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009864 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009865 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9866 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009867 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9868 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009869
9870 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9871
9872 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9873 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9874 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9875 inserted.
9876
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009877 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009878 - accept :
9879 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9880 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9881 the rules evaluation.
9882
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009883 - close :
9884 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9885 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9886 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9887 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9888 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9889 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009890 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009891 protocols.
9892
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009893 - reject :
9894 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9895 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009896 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009897
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009898 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9899 Sets a variable.
9900
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009901 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9902 Unsets a variable.
9903
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009904 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9905 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9906 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9907 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9908
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009909 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9910 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9911 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9912 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9913
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009914 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9915 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9916 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9917 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9918 continues.
9919
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009920 - "silent-drop" :
9921 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009922 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009923 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9924 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9925 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9926 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9927 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009928 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9929 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009930 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9931 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009932 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009933 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9934 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9935 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9936 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9937
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009938 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9939 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9940
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009941 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9942 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9943 for changing the default action to a reject.
9944
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009945 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9946 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9947 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9948 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009949 period.
9950
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009951 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9952 declared inline.
9953
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009954 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9955 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009956 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009957 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9958 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009959 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009960 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009961 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009962 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9963 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009964 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009965 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9966 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009967
9968 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9969 followed by some converters.
9970
9971 Example:
9972
9973 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9974
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009975 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9976 <var-name>.
9977
9978 Example:
9979
9980 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9981
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009982 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9983 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9984 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9985 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9986 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9987
9988 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9989
9990 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9991
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009992 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9993
9994 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9995
9996
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009997tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9998 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10000 no | yes | yes | no
10001 Arguments :
10002 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10003 below.
10004
10005 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10006
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010007 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010008 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10009 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10010 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10011 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10012 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10013 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10014 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010015 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010016 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10017 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10018 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10019 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10020 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10021 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10022 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10023 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10024 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10025 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10026 instead.
10027
10028 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10029 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10030 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10031 rules which may be inserted.
10032
10033 Several types of actions are supported :
10034 - accept : the request is accepted
10035 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10036 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10037 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010038 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010039 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10040 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010041 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010042 - silent-drop
10043
10044 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10045 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10046 sections for a complete description.
10047
10048 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10049 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10050 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10051
10052 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10053 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10054 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10055 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10056 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10057
10058 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10059 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10060
10061 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10062 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10063 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10064
10065 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10066 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10067 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10068
10069 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10070 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10071 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10072
10073 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10074 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10075 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10076
10077 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10078
10079 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10080
10081
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010082tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10083 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10085 no | no | yes | yes
10086 Arguments :
10087 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10088 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10089 as explained at the top of this document.
10090
10091 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10092
10093
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010094timeout check <timeout>
10095 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10096 established.
10097
10098 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10099 yes | no | yes | yes
10100 Arguments:
10101 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10102 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10103 as explained at the top of this document.
10104
10105 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10106 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010107 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010108 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010109 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10110 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10111 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010112
10113 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10114 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10115
10116 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10117 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010118 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010119
10120 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10121 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10122 forget about it.
10123
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010124 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10125 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010126
10127
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010128timeout client <timeout>
10129timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10130 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10132 yes | yes | yes | no
10133 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010134 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010135 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10136 as explained at the top of this document.
10137
10138 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10139 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10140 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010141 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10142 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10143 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10144 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010145 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10146 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10147 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010148 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010149 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010150 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10151 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010152 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10153 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010154
10155 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10156 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10157 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10158 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10159 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10160 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10161
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010162 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010163
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010164 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10165 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10166 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10167
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010168 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10169 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010170
10171
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010172timeout client-fin <timeout>
10173 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10175 yes | yes | yes | no
10176 Arguments :
10177 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10178 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10179 as explained at the top of this document.
10180
10181 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10182 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10183 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10184 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10185 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10186 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10187 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010188 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10189 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10190 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010191
10192 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10193 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10194 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10195
10196 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10197
10198
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010199timeout connect <timeout>
10200timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10201 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10203 yes | no | yes | yes
10204 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010205 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010206 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10207 as explained at the top of this document.
10208
10209 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010210 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010211 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010212 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010213 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10214 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010215
10216 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10217 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10218 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10219 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10220 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10221 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10222
10223 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10224 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10225 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10226
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010227 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10228 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010229
10230
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010231timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10232 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10234 yes | yes | yes | yes
10235 Arguments :
10236 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10237 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10238 as explained at the top of this document.
10239
10240 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10241 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10242 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10243 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10244 once the request has started to present itself.
10245
10246 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10247 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10248 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10249 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10250 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10251
10252 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10253 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10254 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10255 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10256
10257 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10258 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010259 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010260 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10261 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010262 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010263
10264 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10265 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10266 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10267 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10268
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010269 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10270 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010271 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10272
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010273 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10274
10275
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010276timeout http-request <timeout>
10277 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010279 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010280 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010281 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010282 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10283 as explained at the top of this document.
10284
10285 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10286 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10287 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10288 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10289 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10290 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10291 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010292 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10293 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10294 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10295 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010296 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010297 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10298 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010299
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010300 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10301 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10302 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10303 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10304 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010305 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010306
10307 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10308 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010309 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010310 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10311 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10312
10313 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010314 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10315 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10316 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010317
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010318 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010319 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010320
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010321
10322timeout queue <timeout>
10323 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10325 yes | no | yes | yes
10326 Arguments :
10327 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10328 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10329 as explained at the top of this document.
10330
10331 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10332 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10333 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10334 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10335 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10336
10337 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10338 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10339 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10340 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10341
10342 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10343
10344
10345timeout server <timeout>
10346timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10347 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10349 yes | no | yes | yes
10350 Arguments :
10351 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10352 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10353 as explained at the top of this document.
10354
10355 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10356 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10357 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10358 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10359 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10360 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10361 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10362
10363 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10364 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10365 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10366 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10367 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010368 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010369 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010370 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10371 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010372 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10373 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010374
10375 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10376 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10377 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10378 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10379 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10380 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10381
10382 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10383 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10384 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10385
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010386 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010387
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010388
10389timeout server-fin <timeout>
10390 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10392 yes | no | yes | yes
10393 Arguments :
10394 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10395 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10396 as explained at the top of this document.
10397
10398 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10399 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10400 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10401 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10402 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10403 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10404 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10405 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10406 situations, it should not be needed.
10407
10408 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10409 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10410 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10411
10412 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10413
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010414
10415timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010416 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10418 yes | yes | yes | yes
10419 Arguments :
10420 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10421 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10422 as explained at the top of this document.
10423
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010424 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10425 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10426 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10427 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010428
10429 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10430 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10431 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10432 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010433 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010434
10435 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10436
10437
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010438timeout tunnel <timeout>
10439 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10441 yes | no | yes | yes
10442 Arguments :
10443 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10444 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10445 as explained at the top of this document.
10446
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010447 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010448 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10449 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10450 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010451 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10452 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010453 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10454 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10455 specified.
10456
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010457 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10458 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10459 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10460 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10461 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10462 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10463 state.
10464
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010465 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10466 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10467 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10468 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010469 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010470
10471 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10472 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10473 forget about it.
10474
10475 Example :
10476 defaults http
10477 option http-server-close
10478 timeout connect 5s
10479 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010480 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010481 timeout server 30s
10482 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10483
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010484 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010485
10486
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010487transparent (deprecated)
10488 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010490 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010491 Arguments : none
10492
10493 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10494 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10495 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10496 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10497 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10498 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10499 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10500 appropriate server.
10501
10502 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10503
10504 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10505 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10506
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010507 See also: "option transparent"
10508
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010509unique-id-format <string>
10510 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10512 yes | yes | yes | no
10513 Arguments :
10514 <string> is a log-format string.
10515
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010516 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10517 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10518 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10519 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010520
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010521 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10522 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10523 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10524 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10525 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10526 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10527 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10528 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010529
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010530 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10531 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010532
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010533 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010534
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010535 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010536
10537 will generate:
10538
10539 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10540
10541 See also: "unique-id-header"
10542
10543unique-id-header <name>
10544 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10546 yes | yes | yes | no
10547 Arguments :
10548 <name> is the name of the header.
10549
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010550 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10551 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010552
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010553 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010554
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010555 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010556 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10557
10558 will generate:
10559
10560 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10561
10562 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010563
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010564use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010565 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10567 no | yes | yes | no
10568 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010569 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10570 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010571
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010572 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10573 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010574
10575 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10576 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10577 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010578 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010579 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010580 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10581 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010582
10583 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10584 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10585 assign the backend.
10586
10587 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10588 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10589 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10590 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10591 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10592 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10593
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010594 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010595 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010596 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10597 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10598 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10599
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010600 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10601 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10602 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10603 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10604 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10605 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10606 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10607 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10608 cannot be forced from the request.
10609
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010610 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010611 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10612 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10613
10614 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10615 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010616
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010617
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010618use-server <server> if <condition>
10619use-server <server> unless <condition>
10620 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10622 no | no | yes | yes
10623 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010624 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010625
10626 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10627
10628 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10629 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10630 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10631
10632 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10633 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10634 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10635 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10636 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10637 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10638 matches will assign the server.
10639
10640 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10641 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10642 with the next rules until one matches.
10643
10644 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10645 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10646 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10647 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10648
10649 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10650 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10651 stripped.
10652
10653 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10654 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10655 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10656 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10657
10658 Example :
10659 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10660 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10661 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10662 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10663 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10664 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010665 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010666 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10667 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10668
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010669 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010670
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010671
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100106725. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010673--------------------------
10674
10675The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10676depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10677settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10678written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10679described in this section.
10680
10681
106825.1. Bind options
10683-----------------
10684
10685The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10686as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10687no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10688parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10689while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10690provided immediately after the setting name.
10691
10692The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10693
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010694accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10695 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10696 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10697 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10698 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10699 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10700 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10701 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10702 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10703 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010704 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10705 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10706 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010707
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010708accept-proxy
10709 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010710 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10711 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010712 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10713 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10714 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10715 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010716 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010717 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10718 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010719 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10720 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010721
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010722allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010723 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010724 due to security considerations.
10725
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010726alpn <protocols>
10727 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10728 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10729 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10730 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10731 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010732 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10733 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10734 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10735 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10736 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10737 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10738 preference, like below :
10739
10740 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010741
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010742backlog <backlog>
10743 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10744 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10745
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010746curves <curves>
10747 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10748 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10749 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10750 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10751 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10752 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10753
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010754ecdhe <named curve>
10755 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010756 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10757 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010758
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010759ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010760 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10761 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10762 client's certificate.
10763
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010764ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10765 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10766 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10767 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10768 error is ignored.
10769
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010770ca-sign-file <cafile>
10771 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10772 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10773 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10774 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10775 'generate-certificates' for details.
10776
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010777ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010778 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10779 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10780 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10781 'generate-certificates' for details.
10782
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010783ciphers <ciphers>
10784 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10785 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010786 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3. The format of the
10787 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for
10788 instance a string such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without
10789 quotes). Depending on the compatibility and security requirements, the list
10790 of suitable ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background
10791 information and recommendations see e.g.
10792 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10793 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10794 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10795
10796ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10797 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10798 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10799 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10800 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
10801 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section, and can be for instance a
10802 string such as
10803 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
10804 (without quotes). For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check
10805 the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010806
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010807crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010808 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10809 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10810 to verify client's certificate.
10811
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010812crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10814 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10815 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10816 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10817 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10818 file.
10819
10820 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10821 are loaded.
10822
10823 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010824 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010825 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10826 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10827 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10828 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010829 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10830 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010831 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010832
10833 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10834 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10835 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10836 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010837 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10838 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010839
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010840 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010841
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010842 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010843 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010844 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10845 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010846 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10847 clients).
10848
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010849 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10850 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10851 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10852 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10853 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10854 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10855 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10856 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10857 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10858 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10859 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10860 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10861 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10862
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010863 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10864 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10865 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10866 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10867 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10868
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010869 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10870 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10871 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10872 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010873
10874 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10875 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10876 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10877 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10878 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10879 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10880 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10881 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10882 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10883
10884 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10885
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010886 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010887 a cert bundle.
10888
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010889 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010890 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10891 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10892 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10893 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10894 provide multi-cert support.
10895
10896 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10897
10898 Filename | CN | SAN
10899 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10900 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010901 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010902 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10903 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10904
10905 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10906 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10907 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10908 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010909 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10910 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10911 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010912
10913 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10914 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10915
10916 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10917 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10918 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10919
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010920crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010921 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010922 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010923 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010924 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010925
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010926crt-list <file>
10927 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010928 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10929 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010930
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010931 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10932
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010933 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10934 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010935 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010936 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010937
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010938 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10939 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10940 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10941 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10942 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10943 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10944 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10945 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010946
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010947 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010948 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010949 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10950 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10951 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010952
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010953 crt-list file example:
10954 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010955 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010956 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010957 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010958
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010959defer-accept
10960 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10961 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10962 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010963 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010964 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10965 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10966 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10967 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10968 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10969 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10970 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10971
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010972expose-fd listeners
10973 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10974 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010975 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10976 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010977 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010978
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010979force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010980 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010981 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010982 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010983 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010984
10985force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010986 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010987 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010988 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010989
10990force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010991 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010992 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010993 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010994
10995force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010996 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010997 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010998 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010999
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011000force-tlsv13
11001 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11002 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011003 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011004
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011005generate-certificates
11006 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11007 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11008 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11009 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11010 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11011 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11012 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11013 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11014 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11015 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11016 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11017
11018 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11019 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011020 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011021 certificate is used many times.
11022
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011023gid <gid>
11024 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11025 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11026 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11027 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11028 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11029
11030group <group>
11031 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11032 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11033 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11034 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11035 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11036
11037id <id>
11038 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11039 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11040 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11041 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11042
11043interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011044 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11045 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11046 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11047 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11048 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11049 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011050 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11051 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11052 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11053 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11054 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11055 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011056
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011057level <level>
11058 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11059 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11060 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011061 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011062 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11063 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11064 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011065 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011066 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011067 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011068 all counters).
11069
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011070severity-output <format>
11071 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11072 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11073 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11074 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11075 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11076 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11077 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11078 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11079 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11080 rfc5424 convention.
11081
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011082maxconn <maxconn>
11083 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11084 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11085 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11086 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11087 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11088 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11089 eat all memory.
11090
11091mode <mode>
11092 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11093 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11094 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11095 UNIX sockets.
11096
11097mss <maxseg>
11098 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11099 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11100 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11101 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11102 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11103 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11104 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11105 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11106 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11107 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11108 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11109
11110name <name>
11111 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11112 page.
11113
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011114namespace <name>
11115 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11116 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11117 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11118 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11119
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011120nice <nice>
11121 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11122 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11123 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11124 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11125 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11126 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11127 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11128 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11129 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11130 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11131 one for an RDP socket.
11132
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011133no-ca-names
11134 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11135 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11136
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011137no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011138 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011139 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011140 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011141 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011142 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11143 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011144
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011145no-tls-tickets
11146 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11147 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11148 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011149 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11150 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011151
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011152no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011153 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011154 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011155 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011156 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011157 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11158 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011159
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011160no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011161 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011162 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011163 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011164 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011165 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11166 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011167
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011168no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011169 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011170 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011171 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011172 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011173 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11174 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011175
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011176no-tlsv13
11177 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11178 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11179 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11180 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011181 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11182 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011183
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011184npn <protocols>
11185 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11186 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11187 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11188 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011189 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011190 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11191 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11192 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11193 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11194 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011195
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011196prefer-client-ciphers
11197 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11198 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11199 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011200 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11201 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11202 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011203
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011204process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
11205 This restricts the list of processes and/or threads on which this listener is
11206 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011207 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011208 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11209 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11210 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11211 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011212 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011213 connections for this listener, for the corresponding process set. For the
11214 unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
11215 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
11216
11217 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11218
11219 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11220 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11221 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11222 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11223 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11224 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11225 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11226 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011227
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011228proto <name>
11229 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11230 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11231 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11232 in haproxy -vv.
11233 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11234 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
11235 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifing "proto
11236 h2" on the bind line.
11237
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011238ssl
11239 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011240 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011241 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11242 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011243 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11244 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011245
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011246ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11247 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11248 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11249 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11250
11251ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11252 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11253 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11254 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11255
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011256strict-sni
11257 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11258 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11259 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11260 See the "crt" option for more information.
11261
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011262tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011263 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011264 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11265 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011266 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011267 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11268 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11269 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11270 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11271 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11272 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11273 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11274
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011275tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011276 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011277 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11278 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11279 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11280 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11281 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11282 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11283 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011284 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11285 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11286 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011287
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011288tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11289 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
11290 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
11291 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
11292 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
11293 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
11294 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
11295 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
11296 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
11297 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11298 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11299
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011300transparent
11301 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11302 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11303 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11304 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11305 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11306 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11307 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11308 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11309 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11310 so check for support with your vendor.
11311
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011312v4v6
11313 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11314 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11315 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11316 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011317 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011318
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011319v6only
11320 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11321 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11322 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011323 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11324 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011325
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011326uid <uid>
11327 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11328 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11329 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11330 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11331 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11332
11333user <user>
11334 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11335 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11336 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11337 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11338 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11339
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011340verify [none|optional|required]
11341 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11342 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11343 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11344 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11345 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011346 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11347 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11348 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11349 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011350
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200113515.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011352------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011353
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011354The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11355which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11356arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11357settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11358after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11359Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11360address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011361
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011362 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011363 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011364
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011365Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11366keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11367
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011368The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011369
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011370addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011371 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011372 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11373 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11374 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11375 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11376 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011377
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011378agent-check
11379 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011380 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
11381 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
11382 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
11383 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011384
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011385 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011386 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011387 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11388 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11389 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011390
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011391 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11392 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11393 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11394 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11395 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011396
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011397 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011398 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011399
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011400 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11401 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11402 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011403
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011404 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11405 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11406 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011407
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011408 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11409 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11410 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11411 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11412 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011413 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011414 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011415
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011416 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11417 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011418
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011419 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11420 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11421 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11422 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11423 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11424 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11425 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11426 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11427 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011428
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011429 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11430 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011431 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11432 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11433 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011434 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011435
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011436 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011437 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011438
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011439agent-send <string>
11440 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11441 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11442 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11443 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11444 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11445
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011446agent-inter <delay>
11447 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11448 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11449
11450 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11451 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11452 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11453 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11454 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11455 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11456 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11457 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11458 of backends use the same servers.
11459
11460 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11461
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011462agent-addr <addr>
11463 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11464
11465 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11466 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11467 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11468 hostname, it will be resolved.
11469
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011470agent-port <port>
11471 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11472
11473 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11474
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011475backup
11476 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11477 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11478 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11479 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011480 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11481 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011482
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011483ca-file <cafile>
11484 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11485 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11486 server's certificate.
11487
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011488check
11489 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011490 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11491 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11492 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11493 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11494 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11495 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11496 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011497 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11498 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011499 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11500 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011501
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011502check-send-proxy
11503 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11504 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11505 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11506 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11507 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11508 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11509 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11510
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011511check-sni
11512 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
11513 over SSL.
11514
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011515check-ssl
11516 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11517 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11518 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11519 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011520 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011521 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11522 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011523 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011524 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11525 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011526
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011527ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011528 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11529 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11530 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011531 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11532 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11533 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11534 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11535 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11536 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11537
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011538ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11539 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11540 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11541 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11542 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
11543 "man 1 ciphers" under the "ciphersuites" section.
11544
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011545cookie <value>
11546 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11547 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11548 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11549 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11550 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11551 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11552 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11553
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011554crl-file <crlfile>
11555 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11556 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11557 to verify server's certificate.
11558
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011559crt <cert>
11560 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11561 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11562 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11563 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11564 certificate request.
11565
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011566disabled
11567 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11568 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11569 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11570 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11571 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011572 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011573
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011574enabled
11575 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11576 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11577 default value.
11578 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11579 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011581error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011582 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11583 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11584 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011585
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011586 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011587
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011588fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011589 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11590 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11591 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11592
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011593force-sslv3
11594 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11595 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011596 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011597 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011598
11599force-tlsv10
11600 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011601 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011602 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011603
11604force-tlsv11
11605 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011606 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011607 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011608
11609force-tlsv12
11610 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011611 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011612 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011613
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011614force-tlsv13
11615 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11616 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011617 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011619id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011620 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11621 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11622 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011623
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011624init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11625 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11626 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011627 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011628 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11629 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11630 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11631 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11632 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11633 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11634 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11635 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11636 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011637 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011638 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11639 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11640 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11641 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11642 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11643 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011644 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011645
11646 Example:
11647 defaults
11648 # never fail on address resolution
11649 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11650
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011651inter <delay>
11652fastinter <delay>
11653downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011654 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11655 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11656 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11657 between checks depending on the server state :
11658
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011659 Server state | Interval used
11660 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11661 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11662 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11663 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11664 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11665 or yet unchecked. |
11666 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11667 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11668 | "inter" otherwise.
11669 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011671 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11672 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11673 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11674 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011675 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11676 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11677 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11678 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11679 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011680
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011681maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011682 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11683 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11684 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11685 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11686 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11687 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11688 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11689 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11690
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011691maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011692 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11693 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11694 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11695 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11696 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11697 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11698 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11699
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011700minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011701 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11702 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11703 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11704 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11705 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11706 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011707 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011708 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011709
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011710namespace <name>
11711 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11712 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11713 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11714 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11715
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011716no-agent-check
11717 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11718 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11719 default value.
11720 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11721 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11722
11723no-backup
11724 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11725 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11726 default value.
11727 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11728 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11729
11730no-check
11731 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11732 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11733 default value.
11734 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11735 "default-server" "check" setting.
11736
11737no-check-ssl
11738 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11739 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11740 default value.
11741 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11742 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11743
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011744no-send-proxy
11745 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11746 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11747 default value.
11748 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11749 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11750
11751no-send-proxy-v2
11752 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11753 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11754 default value.
11755 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11756 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11757
11758no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11759 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11760 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11761 default value.
11762 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11763 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11764
11765no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11766 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11767 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11768 default value.
11769 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11770 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11771
11772no-ssl
11773 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11774 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11775 default value.
11776 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11777 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11778
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011779no-ssl-reuse
11780 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11781 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11782 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11783 and for paranoid users.
11784
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011785no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011786 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11787 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011788 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011789
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011790 Supported in default-server: No
11791
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011792no-tls-tickets
11793 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11794 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11795 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011796 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11797 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011798 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011799
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011800no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011801 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011802 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11803 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011804 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11805 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011806 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011807
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011808 Supported in default-server: No
11809
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011810no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011811 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011812 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11813 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011814 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11815 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011816 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011817
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011818 Supported in default-server: No
11819
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011820no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011821 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011822 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11823 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011824 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11825 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011826 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011827
11828 Supported in default-server: No
11829
11830no-tlsv13
11831 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11832 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11833 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11834 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11835 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011836 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011837
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011838 Supported in default-server: No
11839
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011840no-verifyhost
11841 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11842 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11843 default value.
11844 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11845 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011846
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011847non-stick
11848 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11849 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11850 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11851
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011852observe <mode>
11853 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11854 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11855 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11856 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11857 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11858 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011859 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011860
11861 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11862
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011863on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011864 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11865 Currently, four modes are available:
11866 - fastinter: force fastinter
11867 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11868 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11869 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11870 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11871
11872 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11873
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011874on-marked-down <action>
11875 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11876 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011877 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11878 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11879 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11880 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11881 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11882 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11883 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11884 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011885
11886 Actions are disabled by default
11887
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011888on-marked-up <action>
11889 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11890 Currently one action is available:
11891 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11892 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11893 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11894 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011895 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11896 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011897 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11898 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11899
11900 Actions are disabled by default
11901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011902port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011903 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11904 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11905 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11906 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11907 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11908 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11909
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020011910proto <name>
11911
11912 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
11913 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
11914 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
11915 reported in haproxy -vv.
11916 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11917 protocol for all connections established to this server.
11918
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011919redir <prefix>
11920 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11921 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11922 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11923 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11924 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11925 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11926 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11927 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011928 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011929 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011930 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11931 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11932 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11933 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11934
11935 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11936
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011937rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011938 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11939 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11940 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11941
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020011942resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
11943 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
11944 server.
11945
11946 Available options:
11947
11948 * allow-dup-ip
11949 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
11950 resolution at runtime is in operation.
11951 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
11952 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
11953 For such case, simply enable this option.
11954 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
11955
11956 * prevent-dup-ip
11957 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
11958 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
11959 same fqdn.
11960 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
11961
11962 Example:
11963 backend b_myapp
11964 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
11965 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11966 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11967
11968 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
11969 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
11970 it
11971 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
11972 different address
11973
11974 Default value: not set
11975
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011976resolve-prefer <family>
11977 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11978 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11979 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11980 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11981
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011982 Default value: ipv6
11983
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011984 Example:
11985
11986 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011987
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011988resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11989 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11990 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011991 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011992 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11993 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011994 configured network, another address is selected.
11995
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011996 Example:
11997
11998 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011999
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012000resolvers <id>
12001 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12002 hostname.
12003
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012004 Example:
12005
12006 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012007
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012008 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012009
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012010send-proxy
12011 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12012 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12013 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12014 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012015 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12016 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12017 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12018 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12019 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12020 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12021 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12022 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12023 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12024 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012025 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12026 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012027
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012028send-proxy-v2
12029 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12030 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12031 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12032 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012033 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12034 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12035 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12036 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012037
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012038proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12039 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12040 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012041 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12042 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012043 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12044 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012045 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012046
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012047send-proxy-v2-ssl
12048 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12049 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12050 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12051 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12052 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12053 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12054 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012055 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12056 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012057
12058send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12059 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12060 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12061 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12062 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12063 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12064 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12065 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12066 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012067 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12068 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012069
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012070slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012071 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12072 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12073 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12074 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12075 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12076 parameters :
12077
12078 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12079 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12080
12081 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12082 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12083 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12084 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12085
12086 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12087 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12088 seen as failed.
12089
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012090sni <expression>
12091 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12092 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12093 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12094 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012095 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12096 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012097 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
12098 "verify" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012099
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012100source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012101source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012102source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012103 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12104 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12105 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12106 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12107
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012108 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12109 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12110 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12111 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12112 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12113 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12114 server.
12115
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012116 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12117 specifying the source address without port(s).
12118
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012119ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012120 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12121 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12122 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12123 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12124 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12125 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012126 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12127 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012128
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012129ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12130 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12131 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12132 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12133
12134ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12135 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12136 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12137 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12138
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012139ssl-reuse
12140 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12141 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12142 default value.
12143 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12144 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12145
12146stick
12147 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12148 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12149 default value.
12150 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12151 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012152
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012153tcp-ut <delay>
12154 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12155 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12156 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012157 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012158 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12159 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12160 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12161 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12162 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12163 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12164 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12165 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12166 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12167
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012168track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012169 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12170 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12171 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12172 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012173 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12174
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012175tls-tickets
12176 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12177 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12178 default value.
12179 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12180 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012181
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012182verify [none|required]
12183 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012184 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012185 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12186 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012187 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012188 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12189 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12190 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12191 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12192 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12193 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12194 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12195 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012196
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012197verifyhost <hostname>
12198 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012199 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12200 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12201 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12202 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12203 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12204 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12205 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12206 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012207
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012208weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012209 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12210 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12211 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012212 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12213 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12214 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12215 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12216 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12217 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012218
12219
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122205.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12221-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012222
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012223HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12224using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12225configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012226This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12227can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12228workload.
12229This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12230resolution at run time.
12231Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12232carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12233
12234
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122355.3.1. Global overview
12236----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012237
12238As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12239different steps of the process life:
12240
12241 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12242 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12243 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12244
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012245 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12246 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012247
12248A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12249 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12250 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12251 resolution to know this new IP.
12252
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012253When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012254HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012255SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12256from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12257will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12258will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012259
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012260A few things important to notice:
12261 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12262 first valid response.
12263
12264 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12265 servers return an error.
12266
12267
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122685.3.2. The resolvers section
12269----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012270
12271This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012272HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12273contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012274
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012275When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12276uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12277is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12278answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12279
12280When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012281used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012282
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012283 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12284 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12285 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012286
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012287 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12288 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012289
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012290 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12291 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12292 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012293
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012294For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12295following scenarios are possible:
12296
12297 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12298 ignored
12299
12300 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12301 applied
12302
12303 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12304 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12305
12306 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12307 retries the query with a new type
12308
12309 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12310 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012311
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012312As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12313a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012314<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012315
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012316
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012317resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012318 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012319
12320A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12321
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012322accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012323 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012324 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012325 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12326 by RFC 6891)
12327
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012328 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12329
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012330nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12331 DNS server description:
12332 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12333 <ip> : IP address of the server
12334 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12335
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012336parse-resolv-conf
12337 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12338 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12339 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12340
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012341hold <status> <period>
12342 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12343 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012344 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012345 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012346 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12347 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12348 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12349
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012350 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012351
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012352resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012353 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12354 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12355 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12356
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012357resolve_retries <nb>
12358 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12359 giving up.
12360 Default value: 3
12361
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012362 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12363 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12364 type.
12365
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012366timeout <event> <time>
12367 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12368 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12369 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012370 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12371 other time applied.
12372 Default value: 1s
12373 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
12374 have been received.
12375 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012376 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12377 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12378
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012379 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012380
12381 resolvers mydns
12382 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12383 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012384 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012385 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012386 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012387 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012388 hold other 30s
12389 hold refused 30s
12390 hold nx 30s
12391 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012392 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012393 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012394
12395
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123966. HTTP header manipulation
12397---------------------------
12398
12399In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12400response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12401request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12402which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012403against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012404
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012405If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12406to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12407but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12408HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12409stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12410because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12411a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12412still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012414This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12415in section 4.2 :
12416
12417 - reqadd <string>
12418 - reqallow <search>
12419 - reqiallow <search>
12420 - reqdel <search>
12421 - reqidel <search>
12422 - reqdeny <search>
12423 - reqideny <search>
12424 - reqpass <search>
12425 - reqipass <search>
12426 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12427 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12428 - reqtarpit <search>
12429 - reqitarpit <search>
12430 - rspadd <string>
12431 - rspdel <search>
12432 - rspidel <search>
12433 - rspdeny <search>
12434 - rspideny <search>
12435 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12436 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12437
12438With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12439is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12440parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12441prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12442Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12443
12444 \t for a tab
12445 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12446 \n for a new line (LF)
12447 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12448 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12449 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12450 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12451 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12452
12453The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12454portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12455above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12456regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
124579 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12458is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12459
12460The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12461after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12462
12463Notes related to these keywords :
12464---------------------------------
12465 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12466 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12467 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12468
12469 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12470 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12471 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12472
12473 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12474 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12475 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12476 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12477 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12478
12479 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12480 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12481 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12482 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12483 useless headers before adding new ones.
12484
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012485 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012486 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12487
12488 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12489 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12490 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12491
12492 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12493 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012494 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012495
12496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200124977. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12498----------------------------------
12499
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012500HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012501client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12502The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12503these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12504but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12505data called patterns.
12506
12507
125087.1. ACL basics
12509---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012510
12511The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12512content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12513from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12514simple :
12515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012516 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012517 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012518 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12519 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012521The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12522adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012523
12524In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012526 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012527
12528This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12529Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12530and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012531an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12532conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12533as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12534are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012535
12536ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12537'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12538which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12539
12540There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12541performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012543The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12544specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12545this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012546methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12547ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012548
12549Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12550 - boolean
12551 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12552 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12553 - string
12554 - data block
12555
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012556Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12557converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12558would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12559The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12560which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12561
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012562Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12563keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12564fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12565which are summarized in the table below :
12566
12567 +---------------------+-----------------+
12568 | Sample or converter | Default |
12569 | output type | matching method |
12570 +---------------------+-----------------+
12571 | boolean | bool |
12572 +---------------------+-----------------+
12573 | integer | int |
12574 +---------------------+-----------------+
12575 | ip | ip |
12576 +---------------------+-----------------+
12577 | string | str |
12578 +---------------------+-----------------+
12579 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12580 +---------------------+-----------------+
12581
12582Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12583matching method, see below.
12584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012585The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12586 - boolean
12587 - integer or integer range
12588 - IP address / network
12589 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12590 - regular expression
12591 - hex block
12592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012593The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12594
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012595 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12596 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012597 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012598 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012599 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012600 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012601 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012603The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12604read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12605if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12606lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12607will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12608beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12609a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12610lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12611exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12612
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012613The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12614parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12615ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12616a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12617check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12618
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012619The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12620socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12621file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012623Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12624loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12625
12626 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12627
12628In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12629the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12630case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12631as well.
12632
12633The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12634sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12635do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12636methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12637is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012638obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012639followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12640default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12641that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12642string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12643
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012644The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12645By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12646string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12647resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12648server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12649waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12650flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12651function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012653There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12654sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12655be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012656
12657 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12658 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012659 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12660 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12661 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12662 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012663
12664 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12665 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012666 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012667
12668 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012669 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012670
12671 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012672 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012673
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012674 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012675 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12676
12677 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12678 binary or string samples.
12679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012680 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12681 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012683 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12684 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12685 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012687 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12688 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012690 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12691 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012693 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12694 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012696 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12697 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012698 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012700 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12701 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12702 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012703
12704For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12705request, it is possible to do :
12706
12707 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12708
12709In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12710buffer, one would use the following acl :
12711
12712 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12713
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012714On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12715possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12716
12717 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012719All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12720criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12721method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12722to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12723criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12724the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012726If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012727the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12728For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012730 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12731 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12732 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12733 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012734
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012735
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012736The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12737types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12738combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12739brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12740default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012742 +-------------------------------------------------+
12743 | Input sample type |
12744 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012745 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012746 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12747 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12748 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012749 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012750 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012751 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012752 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012753 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012754 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012755 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012756 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012757 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012758 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012759 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012760 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012761 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012762 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012763 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012764 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012765 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012766 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012767 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012768 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012769 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012770 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12771 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12772 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012773
12774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200127757.1.1. Matching booleans
12776------------------------
12777
12778In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12779Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12780When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12781that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12782
12783Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12784return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12785"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12786
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200127887.1.2. Matching integers
12789------------------------
12790
12791Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12792enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12793to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12794
12795Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12796matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12797lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012798
12799For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12800unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12801representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12802
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012803As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12804two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12805instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12806ranges and operators.
12807
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012808For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012809operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12810Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12811of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012812
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012813Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012814
12815 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12816 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12817 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12818 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12819 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12820
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012821For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012822
12823 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12824
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012825This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12826
12827 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12828
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128307.1.3. Matching strings
12831-----------------------
12832
12833String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12834different forms :
12835
12836 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012837 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012838
12839 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012840 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012841
12842 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12843 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12844
12845 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12846 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12847
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012848 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012849 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12850 matches.
12851
12852 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12853 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12854 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012855
12856String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12857exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12858characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12859string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12860to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012861before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012862
12863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128647.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12865---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012866
12867Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12868they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12869possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12870passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12871the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012872the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12873match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012874
12875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128767.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12877-------------------------------------
12878
12879It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12880not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12881a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12882to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12883digits may be used upper or lower case.
12884
12885Example :
12886 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12887 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12888
12889
128907.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12891---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012892
12893IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12894netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12895within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012896host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012897difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12898at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12899does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12900parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012901
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012902The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12903abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12904
12905 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12906 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12907 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12908 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12909 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12910 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12911 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12912 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12913
12914Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12915192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12916
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012917IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12918Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12919trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12920IPv6 patterns.
12921
12922HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12923following situations :
12924 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12925 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12926 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12927 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12928 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12929 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12930 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12931 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12932 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12933 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012935
129367.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12937----------------------------------
12938
12939Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12940combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12941
12942 - AND (implicit)
12943 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12944 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012946A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012948 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012950Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12951indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012953For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12954"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12955requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12956is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12957
12958 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012959 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12960 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12961 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012962
12963To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12964and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12965
12966 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12967 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12968 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12969 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12970
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012971 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012972 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12973 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12974 use_backend www if host_www
12975
12976It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12977expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12978be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12979the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12980
12981 The following rule :
12982
12983 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012984 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012985
12986 Can also be written that way :
12987
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012988 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012989
12990It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12991to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12992simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12993sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12994good use is the following :
12995
12996 With named ACLs :
12997
12998 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12999 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13000 monitor fail if site_dead
13001
13002 With anonymous ACLs :
13003
13004 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13005
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013006See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13007keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013008
13009
130107.3. Fetching samples
13011---------------------
13012
13013Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13014against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13015sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13016ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13017of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13018available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13019
13020This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13021Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13022compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13023deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13024
13025The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13026matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13027method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13028indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13029
13030As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13031when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13032mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13033the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13034ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13035
13036Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13037multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13038when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013039incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13040are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013041is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13042all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13043
13044Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13045 - name
13046 - name(arg1)
13047 - name(arg1,arg2)
13048
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013049
130507.3.1. Converters
13051-----------------
13052
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013053Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13054of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13055is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13056was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013057has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013058unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13059
13060These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13061sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13062the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013063support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013064
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013065A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13066support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13067supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13068(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13069bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013071The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013072
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001307351d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13074 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13075 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13076 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13077 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13078 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13079
13080 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013081 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13082 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013083 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13084 frontend http-in
13085 bind *:8081
13086 default_backend servers
13087 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13088 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13089
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013090add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013091 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013092 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013093 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13094 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013095 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013096 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13097 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13098 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13099 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013100 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013101 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013102
13103and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013104 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013105 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013106 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13107 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013108 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013109 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13110 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13111 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13112 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013113 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013114 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013115
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013116b64dec
13117 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13118 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13119
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013120base64
13121 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013122 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013123 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13124
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013125bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013126 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013127 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013128 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013129 presence of a flag).
13130
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013131bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13132 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13133 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013134 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013135
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013136concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13137 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13138 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13139 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13140 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13141 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13142 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13143 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13144 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13145 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13146 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13147 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13148 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13149 delimitors.
13150
13151 Example:
13152 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13153 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13154 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13155 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13156
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013157cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013158 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13159 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013160
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013161crc32([<avalanche>])
13162 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13163 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13164 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13165 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13166 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13167 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13168 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13169 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13170 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13171 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013172 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13173
13174crc32c([<avalanche>])
13175 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13176 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13177 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13178 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13179 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13180 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13181 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13182 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013183
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013184da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013185 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13186 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13187 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13188 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013189 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013190 configuration language.
13191
13192 Example:
13193 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013194 bind *:8881
13195 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013196 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013197
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013198debug
13199 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13200 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13201 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13202
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013203div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013204 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13205 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013206 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013207 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13208 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013209 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013210 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13211 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13212 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13213 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013214 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013215 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013216
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013217djb2([<avalanche>])
13218 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13219 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13220 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13221 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13222 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13223 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13224 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013225 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13226 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013227
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013228even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013229 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013230 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13231
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013232field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13233 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13234 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13235 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13236 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13237 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13238 fields.
13239
13240 Example :
13241 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13242 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13243 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13244 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13245 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013246
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013247hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013248 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013249 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013250 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013251 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013252
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013253hex2i
13254 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13255 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13256
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013257http_date([<offset>])
13258 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13259 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13260 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13261 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13262 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13263 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013264
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013265in_table(<table>)
13266 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13267 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13268 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013269 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013270 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13271
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013272ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13273 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013274 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013275 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13276 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13277 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13278 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13279 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013280
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013281json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013282 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013283 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013284 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013285 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13286 of errors:
13287 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13288 bytes, ...)
13289 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13290 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13291
13292 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13293 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13294 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13295 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13296 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13297 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013298 - "ascii" : never fails;
13299 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13300 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013301 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013302 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013303 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13304 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13305
13306 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013307 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013308
13309 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013310 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013311 capture request header user-agent len 150
13312 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013313
13314 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13315 GET / HTTP/1.0
13316 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13317
13318 Output log:
13319 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13320
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013321language(<value>[,<default>])
13322 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13323 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13324 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13325 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13326 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13327 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13328 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13329 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13330 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013331 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013332 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13333 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013334
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013335 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013336
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013337 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13338 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013339
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013340 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13341 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13342 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13343 use_backend spanish if es
13344 use_backend french if fr
13345 use_backend english if en
13346 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013347
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013348length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013349 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13350 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13351 type. The result is of type integer.
13352
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013353lower
13354 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13355 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13356 type. The result is of type string.
13357
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013358ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13359 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13360 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13361 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13362 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13363 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13364 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13365
13366 Example :
13367
13368 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013369 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013370 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13371
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013372map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13373map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13374map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13375 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13376 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13377 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13378 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13379 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13380 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13381 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13382 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013383
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013384 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13385 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13386 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013387
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013388 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013389 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013390
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013391 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13392 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13393 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13394 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013395 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13396 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013397 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13398 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13399 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13400 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13401 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13402 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13403 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13404 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013405 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13406 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13407 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013408 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13409 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13410 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13411 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13412 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013413
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013414 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13415 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13416 the corresponding match text.
13417
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013418 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13419 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13420 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13421 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13422 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013423
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013424 Example :
13425
13426 # this is a comment and is ignored
13427 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13428 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13429 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13430 | | | `---------- value
13431 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13432 | `---------------------------- key
13433 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13434
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013435mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013436 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13437 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013438 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013439 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013440 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013441 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13442 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13443 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13444 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013445 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013446 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013447
13448mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013449 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013450 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13451 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013452 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013453 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013454 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013455 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13456 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13457 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13458 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013459 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013460 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013461
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013462nbsrv
13463 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13464 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13465 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13466 map lookup.
13467
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013468neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013469 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13470 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13471 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13472 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013473
13474not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013475 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013476 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013477 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013478 absence of a flag).
13479
13480odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013481 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013482 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13483
13484or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013485 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013486 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013487 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13488 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013489 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013490 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13491 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13492 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13493 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013494 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013495 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013496
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013497regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013498 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13499 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13500 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13501 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13502 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13503 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13504 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13505 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13506 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13507 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013508 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13509 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13510 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13511 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013512
13513 Example :
13514
13515 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13516 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13517 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13518 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13519
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013520capture-req(<id>)
13521 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13522 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13523
13524 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013525 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13526 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013527
13528capture-res(<id>)
13529 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13530 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13531
13532 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013533 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13534 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013535
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013536sdbm([<avalanche>])
13537 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13538 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13539 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13540 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13541 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13542 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13543 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013544 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13545 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013546
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013547set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013548 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13549 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13550 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013551 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013552 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13553 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013554 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013555 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13556 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013557 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013558 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013559
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013560sha1
13561 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13562 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13563
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013564strcmp(<var>)
13565 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13566 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13567 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13568 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13569 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13570 shorter).
13571
13572 Example :
13573
13574 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13575 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13576 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13577
13578
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013579sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013580 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13581 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013582 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013583 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13584 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013585 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013586 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13587 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013588 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013589 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13590 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013591 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013592 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013593
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013594table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13595 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13596 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13597 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13598 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13599 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13600 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13601
13602
13603table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13604 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13605 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13606 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13607 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13608 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13609 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13610
13611table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13612 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13613 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013614 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013615 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13616 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13617
13618table_conn_cur(<table>)
13619 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13620 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13621 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13622 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13623 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13624
13625table_conn_rate(<table>)
13626 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13627 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13628 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13629 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13630 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13631
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013632table_gpt0(<table>)
13633 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13634 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13635 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13636 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13637 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13638
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013639table_gpc0(<table>)
13640 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13641 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13642 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13643 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13644 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13645
13646table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13647 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13648 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13649 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13650 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13651 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13652 sample fetch keyword.
13653
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013654table_gpc1(<table>)
13655 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13656 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13657 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13658 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13659 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13660
13661table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13662 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13663 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13664 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13665 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13666 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13667 sample fetch keyword.
13668
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013669table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13670 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13671 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013672 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013673 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13674 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13675
13676table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13677 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13678 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13679 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13680 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13681 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13682 keyword.
13683
13684table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13685 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13686 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013687 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013688 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13689 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13690
13691table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13692 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13693 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13694 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13695 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13696 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13697 keyword.
13698
13699table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13700 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13701 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013702 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013703 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13704 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13705 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13706 keyword.
13707
13708table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13709 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13710 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013711 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013712 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13713 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13714 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13715 keyword.
13716
13717table_server_id(<table>)
13718 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13719 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13720 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13721 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13722 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13723 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13724
13725table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13726 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13727 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013728 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013729 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13730 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13731 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13732 keyword.
13733
13734table_sess_rate(<table>)
13735 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13736 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13737 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13738 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13739 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13740 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13741 keyword.
13742
13743table_trackers(<table>)
13744 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13745 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13746 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13747 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13748 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13749 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13750 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13751 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13752 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13753 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13754
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013755upper
13756 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13757 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13758 type. The result is of type string.
13759
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013760url_dec
13761 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13762 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13763
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013764unset-var(<var name>)
13765 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13766 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13767 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13768 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13769 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13770 response),
13771 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13772 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13773 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13774 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13775
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013776utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13777 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13778 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13779 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13780 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13781 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13782 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13783
13784 Example :
13785
13786 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013787 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013788 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13789
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013790word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13791 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13792 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13793 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13794 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13795 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13796
13797 Example :
13798 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13799 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13800 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13801 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13802 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013803
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013804wt6([<avalanche>])
13805 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13806 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13807 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13808 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13809 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13810 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13811 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013812 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13813 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013814
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013815xor(<value>)
13816 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013817 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013818 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013819 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013820 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013821 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13822 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013823 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013824 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13825 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013826 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013827 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013828
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013829xxh32([<seed>])
13830 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13831 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13832 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13833 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13834 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13835 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13836 as cryptographically secure.
13837
13838xxh64([<seed>])
13839 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13840 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13841 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13842 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13843 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13844 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13845 as cryptographically secure.
13846
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013847
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200138487.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013849--------------------------------------------
13850
13851A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13852not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13853"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13854The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13855
13856always_false : boolean
13857 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13858 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13859
13860always_true : boolean
13861 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13862 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13863
13864avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013865 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013866 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13867 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13868 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13869 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13870 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13871 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13872 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13873 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13874 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13875 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13876 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13877 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13878 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013880be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013881 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13882 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13883 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13884 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040013885 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
13886
13887be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
13888 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
13889 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
13890 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
13891 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
13892 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040013893 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
13894 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040013895
13896 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
13897 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
13898 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013900be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13901 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13902 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13903 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013904 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013905 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13906 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013907
13908 Example :
13909 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13910 backend dynamic
13911 mode http
13912 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13913 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013914
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013915bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013916 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13917 of the string.
13918
13919bool(<bool>) : bool
13920 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13921 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013923connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13924 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013925 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013926 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13927 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013928
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013929 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013930 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013931 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13932
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013933 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13934 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013935
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013936 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013937 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013938 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013939 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013940 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013941 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013942 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013943
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013944 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13945 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013946 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013947 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013948
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013949date([<offset>]) : integer
13950 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13951 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13952 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13953 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013954 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13955
13956 Example :
13957
13958 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13959 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013960
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010013961date_us : integer
13962 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
13963 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
13964 from the same timeval structure.
13965
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020013966distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
13967 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
13968 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
13969 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
13970 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
13971 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
13972 list of supported tokens.
13973
13974distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
13975 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
13976 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
13977 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
13978 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
13979 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
13980 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
13981 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
13982 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
13983 supported tokens.
13984
13985 Example :
13986 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
13987 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
13988 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
13989 # send large files to the big farm
13990 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
13991
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013992env(<name>) : string
13993 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13994 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13995 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13996 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13997 certain way.
13998
13999 Examples :
14000 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14001 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14002
14003 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14004 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014006fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14007 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014008 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14009 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014010 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14011 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014012 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014013 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14014 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014015
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014016fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14017 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14018 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14019 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014021fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14022 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14023 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14024 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14025 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14026 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14027 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14028 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14029 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014030
14031 Example :
14032 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14033 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14034 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14035 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14036 frontend mail
14037 bind :25
14038 mode tcp
14039 maxconn 100
14040 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14041 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14042 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14043 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014044
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014045hostname : string
14046 Returns the system hostname.
14047
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014048int(<integer>) : signed integer
14049 Returns a signed integer.
14050
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014051ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14052 Returns an ipv4.
14053
14054ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14055 Returns an ipv6.
14056
14057meth(<method>) : method
14058 Returns a method.
14059
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014060nbproc : integer
14061 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14062 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14063 and debugging purposes.
14064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014065nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14066 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14067 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14068 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014069 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14070 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14071 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014072
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014073prio_class : integer
14074 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14075 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14076 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14077
14078prio_offset : integer
14079 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14080 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14081 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14082 set-priority-offset".
14083
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014084proc : integer
14085 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14086 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14087 debugging purposes.
14088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014089queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014090 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14091 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14092 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014093 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14094 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14095 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14096 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14097 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14098
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014099rand([<range>]) : integer
14100 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14101 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14102 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14103 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14104 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014106srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14107 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14108 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14109 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14110 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14111 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014112 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14113 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14114
14115srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14116 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14117 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14118 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14119 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14120 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14121 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14122 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14123
14124 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14125 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014126
14127srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14128 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14129 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14130 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014131 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014132 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14133 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14134 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14135
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014136srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14137 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14138 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14139 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14140 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14141 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14142 fetch methods.
14143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014144srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14145 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14146 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014147 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014148 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14149 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014150 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014151 overloading servers).
14152
14153 Example :
14154 # Redirect to a separate back
14155 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14156 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14157 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14158
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014159stopping : boolean
14160 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14161 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14162 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14163
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014164str(<string>) : string
14165 Returns a string.
14166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014167table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14168 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14169 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14170
14171table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14172 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14173 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14174 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14175
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014176thread : integer
14177 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14178 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14179 and debugging purposes.
14180
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014181var(<var-name>) : undefined
14182 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014183 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14184 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014185 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014186 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14187 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014188 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014189 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14190 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014191 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014192 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014193
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200141947.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014195----------------------------------
14196
14197The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14198closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14199methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14200sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14201TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014202the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14203counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014204"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14205used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14206can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14207Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14208table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14209tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14210currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014211
14212be_id : integer
14213 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14214 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14215
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014216be_name : string
14217 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14218 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014220dst : ip
14221 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14222 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14223 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14224 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
14225 RFC 4291.
14226
14227dst_conn : integer
14228 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14229 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14230 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14231 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14232 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14233 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14234 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14235 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014236
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014237dst_is_local : boolean
14238 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14239 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14240 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14241 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014242 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014243 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14244 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14245 it only once per connection.
14246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014247dst_port : integer
14248 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14249 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14250 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14251 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14252 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14253 an HTTP header.
14254
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014255fc_http_major : integer
14256 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14257 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14258 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14259
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014260fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14261 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14262 header.
14263
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014264fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14265 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14266 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14267 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14268 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14269 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14270 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14271
14272fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14273 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14274 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14275 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14276 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14277 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14278 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14279
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014280fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14281 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14282 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14283 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14284 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14285
14286fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14287 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14288 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14289 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14290 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14291
14292fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14293 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14294 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14295 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14296 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14297
14298fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14299 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14300 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14301 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14302 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14303
14304fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14305 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14306 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14307 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14308 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14309
14310fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14311 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14312 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14313 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14314 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14315
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014316fe_defbe : string
14317 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14318 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014320fe_id : integer
14321 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014322 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014323 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14324
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014325fe_name : string
14326 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14327 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14328 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14329
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014330sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014331sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14332sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14333sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014334 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14335 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14336 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14337
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014338sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014339sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14340sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14341sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014342 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14343 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14344 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14345
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014346sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014347sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14348sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14349sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014350 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14351 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014352 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14353 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14354 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014355
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014356 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014357 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14358 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014359 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14360 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14361 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014362 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14363 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14364
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014365sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14366sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14367sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14368sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14369 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14370 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14371 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14372 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14373 when a first ACL was verified.
14374
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014375sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014376sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14377sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14378sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014379 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014380 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14381
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014382sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014383sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14384sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14385sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014386 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14387 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14388 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14389
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014390sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014391sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14392sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14393sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014394 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14395 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14396 See also src_conn_rate.
14397
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014398sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014399sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14400sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14401sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014402 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014403 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014404
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014405sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14406sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14407sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14408sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14409 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14410 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14411
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014412sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14413sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14414sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14415sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14416 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14417 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14418
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014419sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014420sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14421sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14422sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014423 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14424 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14425 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014426 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14427 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14428 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014429
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014430sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14431sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14432sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14433sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14434 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14435 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14436 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14437 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14438 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14439 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14440
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014441sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014442sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14443sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14444sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014445 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014446 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14447 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14448
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014449sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014450sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14451sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14452sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014453 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14454 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14455 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14456 src_http_err_rate.
14457
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014458sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014459sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14460sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14461sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014462 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014463 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14464 src_http_req_cnt.
14465
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014466sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014467sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14468sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14469sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014470 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14471 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14472 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14473 src_http_req_rate.
14474
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014475sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014476sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14477sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14478sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014479 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014480 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14481 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14482 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14483 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014484
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014485 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014486 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14487 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014488 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14489
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014490sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14491sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14492sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14493sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14494 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14495 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14496 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14497 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14498 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14499
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014500sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014501sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14502sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14503sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014504 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14505 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14506 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014507
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014508sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014509sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14510sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14511sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014512 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14513 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14514 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014515
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014516sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014517sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14518sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14519sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014520 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014521 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14522 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14523 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014524 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014525 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14526
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014527sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014528sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14529sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14530sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014531 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14532 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14533 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14534 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14535 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014536 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014537
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014538sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014539sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14540sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14541sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014542 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14543 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14544 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14545
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014546sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014547sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14548sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14549sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014550 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14551 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014552 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014553 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14554 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014555 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14556 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14557 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014559so_id : integer
14560 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14561 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14562 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014564src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014565 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014566 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14567 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14568 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014569 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14570 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14571 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
14572 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014573
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014574 Example:
14575 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14576 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014578src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14579 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14580 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14581 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014582 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014584src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14585 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14586 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014587 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014588 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014590src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14591 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14592 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14593 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14594 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14595 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14596 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014597
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014598 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014599 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14600 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14601 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14602 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014603 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014604 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14605 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14606
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014607src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14608 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14609 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14610 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14611 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14612 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14613 was verified.
14614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014615src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014616 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014617 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014618 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014619 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014621src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014622 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014623 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14624 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014625 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014627src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14628 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14629 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14630 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014631 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014633src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014634 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014635 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014636 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014637 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014638
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014639src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14640 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14641 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14642 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14643 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14644
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014645src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14646 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14647 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14648 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14649 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014651src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014652 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014653 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014654 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14655 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014656 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14657 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14658 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014659
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014660src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14661 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14662 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14663 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14664 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14665 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14666 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14667 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014669src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014670 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014671 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014672 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014673 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014674 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014676src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14677 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14678 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14679 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14680 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014681 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014683src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014684 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014685 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14686 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014687 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014689src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14690 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14691 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14692 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014693 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014694 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014696src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14697 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14698 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14699 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014700 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014701 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14702 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014703
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014704 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014705 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014706 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014707 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014708
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014709src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14710 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14711 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14712 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14713 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14714 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14715 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14716
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014717src_is_local : boolean
14718 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14719 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14720 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14721 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014722 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014723 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14724 once per connection.
14725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014726src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014727 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14728 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14729 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14730 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14731 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014733src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014734 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14735 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14736 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14737 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14738 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014740src_port : integer
14741 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14742 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14743 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14744 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014746src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014747 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014748 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14749 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14750 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014751 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014753src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14754 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14755 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14756 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14757 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014758 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014760src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14761 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14762 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14763 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14764 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14765 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14766 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14767 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14768 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014769
14770 Example :
14771 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14772 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14773 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14774 listen ssh
14775 bind :22
14776 mode tcp
14777 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014778 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014779 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014780 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014782srv_id : integer
14783 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14784 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14785 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014786
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200147877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014788----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014790The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14791closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14792when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14793usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014794future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014795
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001479651d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14797 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14798 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14799 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14800 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14801 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14802
14803 Example :
14804 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14805 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14806 # the request.
14807 frontend http-in
14808 bind *:8081
14809 default_backend servers
14810 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14811 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14812
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014813ssl_bc : boolean
14814 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14815 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
14816 other a server with the "ssl" option.
14817
14818ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
14819 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
14820 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14821
14822ssl_bc_cipher : string
14823 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
14824 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14825
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010014826ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
14827 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14828 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
14829 session or a TLS ticket.
14830
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014831ssl_bc_protocol : string
14832 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
14833 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14834
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014835ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014836 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014837 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14838 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014839
14840ssl_bc_session_id : binary
14841 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
14842 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
14843 if session was reused or not.
14844
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040014845ssl_bc_session_key : binary
14846 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
14847 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
14848 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
14849 BoringSSL.
14850
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014851ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
14852 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
14853 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014855ssl_c_ca_err : integer
14856 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14857 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
14858 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
14859 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
14860 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014862ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
14863 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14864 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
14865 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
14866 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014867
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014868ssl_c_der : binary
14869 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
14870 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14871 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014873ssl_c_err : integer
14874 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14875 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
14876 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
14877 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
14878 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014880ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14881 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14882 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14883 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14884 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14885 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14886 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14887 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14888 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014890ssl_c_key_alg : string
14891 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14892 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14893 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014895ssl_c_notafter : string
14896 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
14897 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14898 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014900ssl_c_notbefore : string
14901 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
14902 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14903 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014905ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14906 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14907 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14908 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14909 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14910 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14911 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14912 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14913 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014915ssl_c_serial : binary
14916 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
14917 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14918 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014920ssl_c_sha1 : binary
14921 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
14922 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
14923 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014924 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
14925 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
14926
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014927 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014928 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014930ssl_c_sig_alg : string
14931 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14932 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14933 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014935ssl_c_used : boolean
14936 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
14937 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014939ssl_c_verify : integer
14940 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
14941 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
14942 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
14943 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014945ssl_c_version : integer
14946 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
14947 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014948
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014949ssl_f_der : binary
14950 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
14951 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14952 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014954ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14955 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14956 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14957 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14958 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014959 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014960 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14961 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14962 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014964ssl_f_key_alg : string
14965 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14966 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
14967 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014969ssl_f_notafter : string
14970 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14971 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14972 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014974ssl_f_notbefore : string
14975 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14976 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14977 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014979ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14980 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14981 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14982 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14983 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14984 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14985 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14986 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14987 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014989ssl_f_serial : binary
14990 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14991 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14992 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014993
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020014994ssl_f_sha1 : binary
14995 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
14996 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
14997 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
14998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014999ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15000 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15001 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15002 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015004ssl_f_version : integer
15005 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15006 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15007
15008ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015009 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15010 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15011 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015013 Example :
15014 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15015 listen http-https
15016 bind :80
15017 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15018 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15019
15020ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15021 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15022 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15023
15024ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015025 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015026 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15027 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15028 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15029 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15030 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15031 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15032 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15033 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015035ssl_fc_cipher : string
15036 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15037 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015038
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015039ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15040 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15041 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015042 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015043
15044ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15045 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15046 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015047 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015048
15049ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15050 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15051 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15052 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015053 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015054 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015055
15056ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15057 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15058 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015059 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015061ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015062 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15063 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015064 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15065 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15066 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15067 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015068
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015069ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15070 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15071 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15072 wait until the handshake happened.
15073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015074ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15075 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015076 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15077 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15078 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15079 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015080
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015081ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015082 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015083 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15084 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015086ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015087 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015088 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15089 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15090 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15091 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15092 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15093 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15094 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015096ssl_fc_protocol : string
15097 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15098 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015099
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015100ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015101 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015102 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15103 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015105ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15106 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15107 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15108 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15109 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015110
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015111ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15112 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15113 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15114 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15115 BoringSSL.
15116
15117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015118ssl_fc_sni : string
15119 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15120 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15121 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15122 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15123 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15124
15125 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15126 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15127 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015128 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15129 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015131 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015132 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15133 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015135ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15136 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15137 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015138
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015139
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151407.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015141------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015143Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15144sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15145only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15146For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15147be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15148can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15149sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15150for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15151content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015153payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015154 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015155 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15156 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015158payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15159 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015160 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015161 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015162
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015163req.hdrs : string
15164 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15165 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15166 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15167 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15168
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015169req.hdrs_bin : binary
15170 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15171 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15172 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15173 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15174 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15175 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15176
15177 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15178
15179 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15180 str: <int:length><bytes>
15181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015182req.len : integer
15183req_len : integer (deprecated)
15184 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15185 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15186 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15187 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15188 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15189 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15190 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15191 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015193req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15194 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015195 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15196 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15197 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15198 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015200 ACL alternatives :
15201 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015203req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15204 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15205 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15206 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15207 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015209 ACL alternatives :
15210 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015212 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015214req.proto_http : boolean
15215req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15216 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15217 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15218 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15219 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15220 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15221 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15222 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015224 Example:
15225 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15226 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15227 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015228 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015230req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15231rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15232 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15233 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15234 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15235 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15236 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15237 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15238 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015240 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15241 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15242 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15243 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15244 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15245 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015247 ACL derivatives :
15248 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015250 Example :
15251 listen tse-farm
15252 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15253 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15254 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15255 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15256 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15257 persist rdp-cookie
15258 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15259 # This is only useful makes sense if
15260 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15261 stick-table type string size 204800
15262 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15263 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15264 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015266 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15267 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015269req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15270rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15271 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15272 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15273 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15274 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015276 ACL derivatives :
15277 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015278
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015279req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15280 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15281 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015282 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15283 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15284 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15285 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15286 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015288req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15289req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15290 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15291 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15292 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15293 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15294 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15295 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15296 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015298req.ssl_sni : string
15299req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15300 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15301 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15302 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15303 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15304 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15305 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15306 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15307 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15308 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15309 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15310 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15311 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015313 ACL derivatives :
15314 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015316 Examples :
15317 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15318 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15319 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15320 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15321 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015322
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015323req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15324 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15325 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15326 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15327 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15328 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15329 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15330 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15331 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15332 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015334req.ssl_ver : integer
15335req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15336 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15337 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15338 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15339 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15340 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15341 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15342 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015343 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015344 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015346 ACL derivatives :
15347 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015348
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015349res.len : integer
15350 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15351 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15352 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15353 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15354 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15355 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15356 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15357 content inspection.
15358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015359res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15360 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015361 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15362 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15363 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15364 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015366res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15367 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15368 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15369 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15370 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015372 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015373
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015374res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15375rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15376 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15377 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15378 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15379 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15380 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15381 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15382 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015384wait_end : boolean
15385 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15386 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015387 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015388 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15389 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015390 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015391 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15392 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015394 Examples :
15395 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15396 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15397 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015399 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15400 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15401 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15402 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15403 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15404 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15405 tcp-request content reject
15406
15407
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154087.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015409--------------------------------------
15410
15411It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15412This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15413data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15414its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15415HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15416content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15417to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15418more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15419response are indexed.
15420
15421base : string
15422 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15423 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15424 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15425 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15426 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15427 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15428 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15429 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15430
15431 ACL derivatives :
15432 base : exact string match
15433 base_beg : prefix match
15434 base_dir : subdir match
15435 base_dom : domain match
15436 base_end : suffix match
15437 base_len : length match
15438 base_reg : regex match
15439 base_sub : substring match
15440
15441base32 : integer
15442 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15443 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15444 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015445 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15446 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15447 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015448
15449base32+src : binary
15450 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15451 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15452 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15453 per-URL counters.
15454
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015455capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15456 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15457 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15458 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15459
15460capture.req.method : string
15461 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15462 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15463 because it's allocated.
15464
15465capture.req.uri : string
15466 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15467 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15468 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15469 allocated.
15470
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015471capture.req.ver : string
15472 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15473 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15474 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15475
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015476capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15477 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15478 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15479 The first entry is an index of 0.
15480 See also: "capture response header"
15481
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015482capture.res.ver : string
15483 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15484 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15485 persistent flag.
15486
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015487req.body : binary
15488 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15489 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15490 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15491 the first chunk is analyzed.
15492
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015493req.body_param([<name>) : string
15494 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15495 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15496 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15497 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15498 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15499 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15500 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15501 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15502 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15503 given.
15504
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015505req.body_len : integer
15506 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15507 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15508 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15509 "option http-buffer-request".
15510
15511req.body_size : integer
15512 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15513 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15514 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15515 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15516 "option http-buffer-request".
15517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015518req.cook([<name>]) : string
15519cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15520 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15521 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15522 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15523 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15524 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15525 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15526 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15527 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15528
15529 ACL derivatives :
15530 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15531 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15532 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15533 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15534 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15535 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15536 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15537 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015539req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15540cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15541 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15542 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015544req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15545cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15546 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15547 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15548 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15549 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015551cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15552 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15553 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15554 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15555 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015556 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015557 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15558 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15559 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15560 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015562hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15563 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15564 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15565 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15566 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015567 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015569req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15570 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15571 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15572 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15573 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15574 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15575 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15576 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15577 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015579req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15580 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15581 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15582 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15583 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015585req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15586 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15587 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15588 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15589 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15590 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15591 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15592 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15593 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015594 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015595 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015596 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015598 ACL derivatives :
15599 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15600 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15601 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15602 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15603 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15604 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15605 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15606 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15607
15608req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15609hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15610 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15611 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15612 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15613 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15614 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15615 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15616 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15617 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15618 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15619
15620req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15621hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15622 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15623 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15624 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15625 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15626 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015627 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015628 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15629 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15630
15631req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15632hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15633 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15634 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15635 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15636 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15637 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15638 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15639 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15640
15641http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15642 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15643 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15644 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15645 basic auth is supported.
15646
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015647http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15648 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15649 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15650 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15651 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015652 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15653 basic auth is supported.
15654
15655 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015656 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15657 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15658 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15659 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015660
15661http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015662 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
15663 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015664 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
15665 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015667method : integer + string
15668 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
15669 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
15670 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
15671 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
15672 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
15673 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
15674 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015676 ACL derivatives :
15677 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015679 Example :
15680 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
15681 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
15682 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015684path : string
15685 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
15686 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
15687 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
15688 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
15689 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015690 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015691 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015693 ACL derivatives :
15694 path : exact string match
15695 path_beg : prefix match
15696 path_dir : subdir match
15697 path_dom : domain match
15698 path_end : suffix match
15699 path_len : length match
15700 path_reg : regex match
15701 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015702
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015703query : string
15704 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
15705 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
15706 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
15707 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015708 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015709 which stops before the question mark.
15710
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015711req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15712 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15713 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15714 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15715 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015717req.ver : string
15718req_ver : string (deprecated)
15719 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
15720 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
15721 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015723 ACL derivatives :
15724 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015726res.comp : boolean
15727 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
15728 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
15729 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015731res.comp_algo : string
15732 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
15733 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
15734 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015736res.cook([<name>]) : string
15737scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15738 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15739 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15740 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015742 ACL derivatives :
15743 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015745res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15746scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15747 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15748 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
15749 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015751res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15752scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15753 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15754 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
15755 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015757res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15758 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15759 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15760 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15761 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15762 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
15763 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
15764 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
15765 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
15766 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015768res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15769 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15770 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15771 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15772 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
15773 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015775res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15776shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
15777 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15778 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15779 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15780 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15781 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
15782 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
15783 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
15784 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015786 ACL derivatives :
15787 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15788 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15789 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15790 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15791 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15792 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15793 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15794 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15795
15796res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15797shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15798 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15799 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15800 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
15801 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
15802 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015804res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15805shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15806 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
15807 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
15808 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
15809 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
15810 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
15811 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015812
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015813res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15814 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15815 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15816 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15817 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015819res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15820shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15821 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
15822 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15823 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15824 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15825 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
15826 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015828res.ver : string
15829resp_ver : string (deprecated)
15830 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
15831 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015833 ACL derivatives :
15834 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015836set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15837 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15838 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015839 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015840 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015842 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
15843 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015845status : integer
15846 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
15847 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
15848 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015849
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020015850unique-id : string
15851 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
15852 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
15853 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
15854 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
15855 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
15856 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
15857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015858url : string
15859 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
15860 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
15861 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
15862 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
15863 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
15864 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
15865 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015867 ACL derivatives :
15868 url : exact string match
15869 url_beg : prefix match
15870 url_dir : subdir match
15871 url_dom : domain match
15872 url_end : suffix match
15873 url_len : length match
15874 url_reg : regex match
15875 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015877url_ip : ip
15878 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
15879 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
15880 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
15881 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
15882 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
15883 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15884 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015886url_port : integer
15887 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
15888 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
15889 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15890 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015891
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015892urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
15893url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015894 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
15895 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015896 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
15897 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
15898 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
15899 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015900 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
15901 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015902 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
15903 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015905 ACL derivatives :
15906 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
15907 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
15908 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
15909 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
15910 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
15911 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
15912 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
15913 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015914
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015916 Example :
15917 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
15918 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
15919 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
15920 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015921
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015922urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015923 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
15924 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
15925 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020015926
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020015927url32 : integer
15928 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
15929 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
15930 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
15931 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
15932 is an unsigned integer.
15933
15934url32+src : binary
15935 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
15936 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
15937 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
15938
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010015939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159407.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015941---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015942
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015943Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
15944every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020015945order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015946
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015947ACL name Equivalent to Usage
15948---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015949FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020015950HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015951HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
15952HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015953HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
15954HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
15955HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
15956HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
15957LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015958METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015959METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015960METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
15961METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
15962METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
15963METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015964METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015965METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015966RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015967REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015968TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015969WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
15970---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015971
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010015972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159738. Logging
15974----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015975
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015976One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
15977provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
15978very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
15979provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
15980state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015981to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015982headers.
15983
15984In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
15985about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
15986send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
15987
15988 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
15989 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
15990 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
15991 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
15992 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015993 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060015994 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015995
15996The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
15997allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
15998as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
15999while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16000real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16001delay.
16002
16003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160048.1. Log levels
16005---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016006
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016007TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016008source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016009HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16010in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16011track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16012syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16013about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016014
16015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160168.2. Log formats
16017----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016018
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016019HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016020and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16021slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16022options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016023
16024 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16025 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16026 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16027 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16028 extents.
16029
16030 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16031 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16032 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16033 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16034 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16035
16036 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16037 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16038 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16039 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16040 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16041
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016042 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16043 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16044 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16045 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16046
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016047 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16048
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016049Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16050specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16051field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16052servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16053always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16054identifier.
16055
16056Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16057 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16058 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16059 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16060 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16061
16062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160638.2.1. Default log format
16064-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016065
16066This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16067as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16068format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16069
16070 Example :
16071 listen www
16072 mode http
16073 log global
16074 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16075
16076 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16077 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16078 (www/HTTP)
16079
16080 Field Format Extract from the example above
16081 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16082 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16083 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16084 4 'to' to
16085 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16086 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16087
16088Detailed fields description :
16089 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16090 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16091 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16092 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16093 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16094 and processed the connection.
16095 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16096
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016097In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16098"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16099connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16100
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016101It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16102will eventually disappear.
16103
16104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161058.2.2. TCP log format
16106---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016107
16108The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16109is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16110information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16111counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16112emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16113environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16114the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16115sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016116specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16117not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16118fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16119marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016120
16121 Example :
16122 frontend fnt
16123 mode tcp
16124 option tcplog
16125 log global
16126 default_backend bck
16127
16128 backend bck
16129 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16130
16131 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16132 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16133 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16134
16135 Field Format Extract from the example above
16136 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16137 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16138 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16139 4 frontend_name fnt
16140 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16141 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16142 7 bytes_read* 212
16143 8 termination_state --
16144 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16145 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16146
16147Detailed fields description :
16148 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016149 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16150 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16151 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016152 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016153 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016154 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016155
16156 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016157 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16158 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16159 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016160
16161 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16162 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16163 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016164 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16165 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16166 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16167 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016168
16169 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16170 and processed the connection.
16171
16172 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16173 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16174 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16175 applications.
16176
16177 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16178 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16179 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16180 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16181 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16182
16183 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16184 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16185 See "Timers" below for more details.
16186
16187 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16188 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16189 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16190 "Timers" below for more details.
16191
16192 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016193 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016194 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16195 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16196 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16197 details.
16198
16199 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16200 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16201 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16202 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16203 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16204
16205 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16206 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16207 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16208 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16209 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16210 for more details.
16211
16212 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016213 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016214 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16215 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16216 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016217 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016218
16219 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16220 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16221 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16222 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16223 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16224 caused by a denial of service attack.
16225
16226 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16227 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16228 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16229 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16230 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16231 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16232 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16233 denial of service attack.
16234
16235 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16236 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16237 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16238 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16239 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16240 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16241 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16242 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16243 be processed than on other servers.
16244
16245 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16246 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16247 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16248 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16249 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16250 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16251 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16252 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16253 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16254 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16255 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16256 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16257 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16258
16259 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16260 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16261 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16262 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16263 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16264 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016265 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016266 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16267
16268 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16269 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16270 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16271 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16272 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16273 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016274 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016275 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16276 occurs.
16277
16278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162798.2.3. HTTP log format
16280----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016281
16282The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16283is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16284the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16285are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16286emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16287generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16288"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16289which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016290frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16291is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016292
16293Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16294slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16295with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16296
16297 Example :
16298 frontend http-in
16299 mode http
16300 option httplog
16301 log global
16302 default_backend bck
16303
16304 backend static
16305 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16306
16307 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16308 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16309 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016310 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016311
16312 Field Format Extract from the example above
16313 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16314 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016315 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016316 4 frontend_name http-in
16317 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016318 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016319 7 status_code 200
16320 8 bytes_read* 2750
16321 9 captured_request_cookie -
16322 10 captured_response_cookie -
16323 11 termination_state ----
16324 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16325 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16326 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16327 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16328 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016329
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016330Detailed fields description :
16331 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016332 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16333 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16334 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016335 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016336 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016337 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016338
16339 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016340 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16341 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16342 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016343
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016344 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16345 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016346
16347 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16348 and processed the connection.
16349
16350 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16351 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16352 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16353
16354 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16355 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16356 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16357 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16358 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16359 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16360
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016361 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16362 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16363 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16364 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16365 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16366 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016367 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16368 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016369
16370 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16371 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016372 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016373
16374 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16375 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016376 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16377 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016378
16379 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16380 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16381 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16382 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16383 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016384 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16385 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016386
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016387 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16388 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16389 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16390 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16391 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16392 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16393 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016394 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016395
16396 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16397 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16398 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16399
16400 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16401 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16402 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16403 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16404 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16405 overflowing.
16406
16407 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16408 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16409 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16410 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16411 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16412 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16413 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16414 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16415
16416 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16417 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16418 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16419 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16420 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16421 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16422 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16423 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16424
16425 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16426 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16427 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16428 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16429 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16430 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16431 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16432
16433 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016434 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016435 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16436 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16437 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016438 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016439 system.
16440
16441 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16442 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16443 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16444 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16445 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16446 caused by a denial of service attack.
16447
16448 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16449 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16450 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16451 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16452 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16453 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16454 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16455 denial of service attack.
16456
16457 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16458 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16459 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16460 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16461 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16462 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16463 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16464 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16465 processed than on other servers.
16466
16467 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16468 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16469 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16470 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16471 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16472 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16473 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16474 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16475 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16476 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16477 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16478 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16479 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16480
16481 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16482 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16483 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16484 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16485 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16486 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016487 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016488 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16489
16490 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16491 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16492 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16493 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16494 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16495 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016496 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016497 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16498 occurs.
16499
16500 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16501 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16502 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16503 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16504 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16505 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16506 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16507 cookies" below for more details.
16508
16509 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16510 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16511 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16512 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16513 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16514 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16515 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16516 and cookies" below for more details.
16517
16518 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16519 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16520 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16521 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16522 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16523 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16524 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16525 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16526
16527
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200165288.2.4. Custom log format
16529------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016530
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016531The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016532mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016533
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016534HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016535Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16536separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16537prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16538
16539Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16540variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016541("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016542
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016543If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016544as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016545less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16546the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16547
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016548Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016549In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016550in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016551
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016552Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16553'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16554https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16555such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16556
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016557Flags are :
16558 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016559 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016560 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16561 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016562
16563 Example:
16564
16565 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16566 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16567
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016568 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16569
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016570At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16571
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016572 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16573 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016574
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016575the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016576
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016577 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16578 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16579 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016580
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016581and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16582
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016583 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16584 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016585
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016586Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16587
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016588 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016589 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016590 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16591 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16592 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016593 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16594 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16595 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016596 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016597 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16598 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016599 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016600 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16601 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016602 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016603 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016604 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016605 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016606 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016607 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016608 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016609 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16610 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16611 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16612 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16613 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016614 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016615 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16616 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016617 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016618 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16619 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016620 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16621 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16622 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016623 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016624 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16625 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016626 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016627 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16628 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16629 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016630 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016631 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016632 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16633 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16634 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16635 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016636 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016637 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016638 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016639 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016640 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016641 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016642 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16643 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16644 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016645 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016646 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16647 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016648 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016649 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16650 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020016651 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016652 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016653 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016654 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016655
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016656 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016657
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016658
166598.2.5. Error log format
16660-----------------------
16661
16662When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
16663protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
16664By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
16665"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016666will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016667logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
16668
16669The format looks like this :
16670
16671 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
16672 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
16673 Connection error during SSL handshake
16674
16675 Field Format Extract from the example above
16676 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
16677 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
16678 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
16679 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
16680 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
16681
16682These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
16683failures.
16684
16685
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166868.3. Advanced logging options
16687-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016688
16689Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
16690just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
16691options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
16692for more information about their usage.
16693
16694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
16696------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016697
16698It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
16699haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
16700commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
16701monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
16702ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
16703
16704 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
16705 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
16706 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
16707 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
16708
16709 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
16710 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
16711 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016712 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016713 such as other load-balancers.
16714
16715 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
16716 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
16717 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
16718
16719
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167208.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
16721----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016722
16723The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
16724what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
16725or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016726"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016727just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
16728log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
16729after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
16730is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
16731with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
16732with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
16733
16734
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167358.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
16736------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016737
16738Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
16739for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
16740"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
16741retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
16742raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
16743a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
16744file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
16745you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
16746"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
16747
16748
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167498.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
16750--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016751
16752Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
16753multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
16754them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
16755"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
16756logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
16757error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
16758and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
16759too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
16760useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
16761alternative.
16762
16763
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167648.4. Timing events
16765------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016766
16767Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
16768reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
16769the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
16770frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016771mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
16772addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
16773
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010016774Timings events in HTTP mode:
16775
16776 first request 2nd request
16777 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
16778 t tr t tr ...
16779 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
16780 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
16781 :<---- Tq ---->: :
16782 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
16783 :<--------- Ta --------->:
16784
16785Timings events in TCP mode:
16786
16787 TCP session
16788 |<----------------->|
16789 t t
16790 ---|----|----|----|----|---
16791 | Th Tw Tc Td |
16792 |<------ Tt ------->|
16793
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016794 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016795 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016796 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
16797 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
16798 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016799 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016800 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
16801 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
16802 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
16803 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016804
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016805 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
16806 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
16807 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016808 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
16809 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
16810 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
16811 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
16812 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
16813 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016814
16815 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
16816 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
16817 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
16818 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
16819 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
16820 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
16821 request typed by hand during a test.
16822
16823 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
16824 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016825 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016826 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
16827 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
16828 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
16829 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016830
16831 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
16832 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
16833 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
16834 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
16835 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
16836
16837 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
16838 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
16839 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
16840 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
16841 connection never established.
16842
16843 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
16844 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
16845 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
16846 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
16847 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
16848 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
16849 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
16850 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
16851 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
16852 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
16853 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
16854
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016855 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
16856 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
16857 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
16858 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
16859 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
16860 by subtracting other timers when valid :
16861
16862 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
16863
16864 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
16865 "Ta" can never be negative.
16866
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016867 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
16868 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016869 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
16870 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016871 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016872
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016873 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016874
16875 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016876 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
16877 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016878
16879These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
16880protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
16881that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016882due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
16883"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
16884that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016885
16886Most common cases :
16887
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016888 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
16889 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
16890 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
16891 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
16892 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
16893 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
16894 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
16895 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
16896 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
16897 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
16898 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020016899 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016900
16901 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
16902 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
16903 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
16904 of ms on remote networks.
16905
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016906 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
16907 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
16908 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016909
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016910 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
16911 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
16912 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
16913 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
16914 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
16915 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
16916 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
16917 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
16918 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016919
16920Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
16921
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016922 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016923 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016924 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016925
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016926 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016927 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
16928 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
16929
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016930 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016931 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
16932 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
16933 flags.
16934
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016935 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
16936 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016937 Check the session termination flags, then check the
16938 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
16939 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
16940 the client connection was maintained open.
16941
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016942 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016943 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016944 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016945 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
16946
16947
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169488.5. Session state at disconnection
16949-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016950
16951TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
16952"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
169532-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
16954each of which has a special meaning :
16955
16956 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
16957 session to terminate :
16958
16959 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
16960
16961 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
16962 server explicitly refused it.
16963
16964 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
16965 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
16966 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
16967 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016968 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016969
16970 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
16971 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016972
16973 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
16974 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
16975 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
16976 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
16977 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
16978
16979 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
16980 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
16981 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
16982 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
16983 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
16984
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090016985 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
16986 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
16987
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016988 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
16989 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
16990 backup connections when going up.
16991
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020016992 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
16993
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016994 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
16995 send or receive data.
16996
16997 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
16998 send or receive data.
16999
17000 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17001 with nothing left in the buffers.
17002
17003 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17004
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017005 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017006 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17007
17008 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17009 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17010 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17011 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17012 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17013
17014 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17015 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17016
17017 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17018 server (HTTP only).
17019
17020 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17021
17022 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17023 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17024 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17025
17026 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17027 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17028 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17029
17030 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17031
17032 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17033 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17034
17035 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17036 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17037 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17038
17039 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17040 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017041 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17042 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017043
17044 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17045 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17046 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17047 another server.
17048
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017049 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017050 server.
17051
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017052 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17053 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17054 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17055 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17056
17057 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17058 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17059 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17060 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17061
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017062 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17063 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17064 "use-server" rule).
17065
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017066 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17067
17068 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17069 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17070
17071 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17072
17073 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17074 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17075 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17076
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017077 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17078 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017079 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017080 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17081 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17082
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017083 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17084
17085 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17086 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17087
17088 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17089
17090 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17091
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017092The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17093was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017094helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17095starvation, attacks, etc...
17096
17097The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17098alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17099easier finding and understanding.
17100
17101 Flags Reason
17102
17103 -- Normal termination.
17104
17105 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17106 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17107 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17108 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17109
17110 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17111 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17112 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17113 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17114 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17115 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017116
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017117 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17118 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017119 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017120
17121 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17122 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17123 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17124
17125 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17126 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17127 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17128 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17129 the server takes too long to respond.
17130
17131 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17132 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17133 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17134 long a time to respond.
17135
17136 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17137 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17138 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17139 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017140 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17141 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017142
17143 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17144 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17145 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17146 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17147 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017148 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017149 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17150 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17151 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17152 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17153 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17154 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17155 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17156 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017157 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017158 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17159 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17160 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017161
17162 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17163 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017164 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17165 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17166 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17167 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017168
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017169 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17170 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17171
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017172 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017173 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17174 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017175 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017176 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17177 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17178
17179 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17180 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17181 503 or 504 here.
17182
17183 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17184 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17185 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17186 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17187 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17188
17189 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17190 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017191 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017192 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17193 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17194
17195 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17196 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17197 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17198 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17199 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17200 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17201 between haproxy and the server.
17202
17203 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17204 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17205 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17206 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17207 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17208 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17209 solution is to fix the application.
17210
17211 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17212 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17213 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17214 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17215 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17216 external attacks.
17217
17218 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17219 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017220 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017221 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17222 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17223
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017224 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17225 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17226 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017227 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017228 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017230 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17231 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17232 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17233 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017234 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17235 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17236 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17237 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17238 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017239
17240 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17241 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17242 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17243 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17244
17245 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17246 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17247 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17248 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17249
17250 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17251 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17252 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17253 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17254
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017255The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17256persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17257important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17258re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17259
17260 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17261
17262 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17263 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17264 set on a GET request.
17265
17266 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17267 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017268 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017269 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17270
17271 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17272 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17273 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17274
17275 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17276 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17277 already got a cookie.
17278
17279 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17280 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17281 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17282 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17283 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17284
17285 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17286 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17287 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17288
17289 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17290 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17291 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17292
17293 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17294 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17295
17296 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17297 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17298 then advertised in the response.
17299
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173018.6. Non-printable characters
17302-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017303
17304In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17305consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17306converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17307prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17308being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17309escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17310is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17311'}' when logging headers.
17312
17313Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17314issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17315containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17316
17317Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17318the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17319performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17320
17321
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173228.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17323---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017324
17325Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17326achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017327section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017328cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17329the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17330the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017331locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017332not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17333user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17334a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17335wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17336
17337 Examples :
17338 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17339 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17340
17341 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17342 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17343
17344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173458.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17346---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017347
17348Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17349proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17350the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17351server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17352
17353Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17354response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017355section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017356
17357It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017358time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17359appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017360are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17361and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17362follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17363request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17364in the logs.
17365
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017366As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17367frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17368an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17369
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017370 Example :
17371 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17372 listen proxy-out
17373 mode http
17374 option httplog
17375 option logasap
17376 log global
17377 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17378
17379 # log the name of the virtual server
17380 capture request header Host len 20
17381
17382 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17383 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17384
17385 # log the beginning of the referrer
17386 capture request header Referer len 20
17387
17388 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17389 capture response header Server len 20
17390
17391 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17392 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17393
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017394 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017395 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17396
17397 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17398 capture response header Via len 20
17399
17400 # log the URL location during a redirection
17401 capture response header Location len 20
17402
17403 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17404 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17405 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17406 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17407 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17408
17409 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17410 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17411 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17412 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017413 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017414
17415 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17416 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17417 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17418 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17419 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017420 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017421
17422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174238.9. Examples of logs
17424---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017425
17426These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17427them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17428reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17429
17430 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17431 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17432 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17433
17434 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17435 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17436
17437 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17438 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17439 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17440
17441 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17442 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17443
17444 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17445 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17446 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17447
17448 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017449 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017450 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17451 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17452
17453 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17454 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17455 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17456
17457 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17458 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017459 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017460 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17461 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17462 to return the 502 and not the server.
17463
17464 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017465 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017466
17467 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17468 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17469 Nothing was sent to any server.
17470
17471 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17472 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17473
17474 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17475 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017476 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017477 send a 408 return code to the client.
17478
17479 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17480 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17481
17482 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17483 5 seconds ("c----").
17484
17485 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17486 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017487 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017488
17489 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017490 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017491 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17492 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17493 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17494 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17495 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017496
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017497
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200174989. Supported filters
17499--------------------
17500
17501Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17502accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17503unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17504
17505See also : "filter"
17506
175079.1. Trace
17508----------
17509
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017510filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017511
17512 Arguments:
17513 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17514 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17515
17516 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17517 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17518 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17519 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17520
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017521 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017522 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17523 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17524 amount of the parsed data.
17525
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017526 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017527
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017528This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17529callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17530information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17531filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17532
17533Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17534tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17535a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17536
17537
175389.2. HTTP compression
17539---------------------
17540
17541filter compression
17542
17543The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17544keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
17545when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
17546use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
17547used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
17548filters evaluation order.
17549
17550See also : "compression"
17551
17552
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200175539.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17554--------------------------------------------
17555
17556filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17557
17558 Arguments :
17559
17560 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17561 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17562 parsed.
17563
17564 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17565 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17566 part must be placed in its own scope.
17567
17568The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17569external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017570streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017571exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17572also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17573
17574SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17575the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17576
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017577For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017578"doc/SPOE.txt".
17579
17580Important note:
17581 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17582 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17583
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001758410. Cache
17585---------
17586
17587HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17588(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17589RAM.
17590
17591The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017592this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017593
17594If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17595independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17596when we try to allocate a new one.
17597
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017598The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017599
17600It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17601"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17602for more details.
17603
17604When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17605replaced by "<CACHE>".
17606
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001760710.1. Limitation
17608----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017609
17610The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17611
17612- If the response is not a 200
17613- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017614- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017615- If the response is not cacheable
17616
17617- If the request is not a GET
17618- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020017619- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017620
17621Caution!: Due to the current limitation of the filters, it is not recommended
17622to use the cache with other filters. Using them can cause undefined behavior
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017623if they modify the response (compression for example).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017624
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001762510.2. Setup
17626-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017627
17628To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17629the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17630
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001763110.2.1. Cache section
17632---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017633
17634cache <name>
17635 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17636 size of cache is mandatory.
17637
17638total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017639 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020017640 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017641
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017642max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020017643 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
17644 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
17645 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017646
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017647max-age <seconds>
17648 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
17649 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17650 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17651 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
17652 default.
17653
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001765410.2.2. Proxy section
17655---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017656
17657http-request cache-use <name>
17658 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
17659 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
17660 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
17661 after this one.
17662
17663http-response cache-store <name>
17664 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
17665 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
17666 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
17667 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
17668
17669
17670Example:
17671
17672 backend bck1
17673 mode http
17674
17675 http-request cache-use foobar
17676 http-response cache-store foobar
17677 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
17678
17679 cache foobar
17680 total-max-size 4
17681 max-age 240
17682
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017683/*
17684 * Local variables:
17685 * fill-column: 79
17686 * End:
17687 */